FIELD OF THE INVENTION
[0001] The present invention relates to compounds capable of inhibiting the tyrosine kinase
enzymatic activity of the Abelson protein (ABL1), the Abelson-related protein (ABL2)
and related chimeric proteins, in particular BCR-ABL1. The invention further relates
to a process for the preparation of compounds of the invention, pharmaceutical preparations
comprising such compounds and methods of using such compounds in the treatment of
cancers.
BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
[0002] The tyrosine kinase activity of the ABL1 protein is normally tightly regulated, with
the
N-terminal cap region of the SH3 domain playing an important role. One regulatory mechanism
involves the
N-terminal cap glycine-2 residue being myristoylated and then interacting with a myristate
binding site within the SHI catalytic domain. A hallmark of chronic myeloid leukemia
(CML) is the Philadelphia chromosome (Ph), formed by the t(9,22) reciprocal chromosome
translocation in a haematopoietic stem cell. This chromosome carries the BCR-ABL1
oncogene which encodes the chimeric BCR-ABL1 protein, that lacks the
N-terminal cap and has a constitutively active tyrosine kinase domain.
[0003] Although drugs that inhibit the tyrosine kinase activity of BCR-ABL1 via an ATP-competitive
mechanism, such as Gleevec® / Glivec® (imatinib), Tasigna® (nilotinib) and Sprycel®
(dasatinib), are effective in the treatment of CML, some patients relapse due to the
emergence of drug-resistant clones, in which mutations in the SHI domain compromise
inhibitor binding. Although Tasigna® and Sprycel® maintain efficacy towards many Gleevec-resistant
mutant forms of BCR-ABL1, the mutation in which the threonine-315 residue is replaced
by an isoleucine (T315I) remains insensitive to all three drugs and can result in
CML patients developing resistance to therapy. Therefore, inhibiting BCR-ABL1 mutations,
such as T315I, remains an unmet medical need. In addition to CML, BCR-ABL1 fusion
proteins are causative in a percentage of acute lymphocytic leukemias, and drugs targeting
ABL kinase activity also have utility in this indication.
[0004] Agents targeting the myristoyl binding site (so-called allosteric inhibitors) have
potential for the treatment of BCR-ABL1 disorders (
J. Zhang, F. J. Adrian, W. Jahnke, S. W. Cowan-Jacob, A. G. Li, R. E. Iacob4, T. Sim,
J. Powers, C. Dierks, F. Sun, G.-R. Guo, Q. Ding, B. Okram, Y. Choi, A. Wojciechowski,
X. Deng, G. Liu, G. Fendrich, A. Strauss, N. Vajpai, S. Grzesiek, T. Tuntland, Y.
Liu, B. Bursulaya, M. Azam, P. W. Manley, J. R. Engen, G. Q. Daley, M. Warmuth., N.
S. Gray. Targeting BCR-ABL by combining allosteric with ATP-binding-site inhibitors.
Nature 2010;463:501-6). To prevent the emergence of drug resistance from ATP inhibitor and/or allosteric
inhibitor use, a combination treatment using both types of inhibitor can be developed
for the treatment of BCR-ABL1 related disorders. In particular, the need exists for
small molecules, or combinations thereof, that inhibit the activity of BCR-ABL 1 and
BCR-ABL 1 mutations via the ATP binding site, the myristoyl binding site or a combination
of both sites.
[0005] Further, inhibitors of ABL1 kinase activity have the potential to be used as therapies
for the treatment of metastatic invasive carcinomas and viral infections such as pox
and Ebola viruses.
[0006] The compounds from the present invention also have the potential to treat or prevent
diseases or disorders associated with abnormally activated kinase activity of
wild-type ABL1, including non-malignant diseases or disorders, such as CNS diseases in particular
neurodegenerative diseases (for example Alzheimer's, Parkinson's diseases), motoneuroneuron
diseases (amyotophic lateral sclerosis), muscular dystrophies, autoimmune and inflammatory
diseases (diabetes and pulmonary fibrosis), viral infections, prion diseases.
[0007] WO 2004/005281 A1 discloses substituted pyrimidinylaminobenzamides as inhibitors of tyrosine kinases.
SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
[0009] In one aspect, the present invention provides compounds of formula (I):

in which:
R1 is pyrazolyl; wherein said pyrazolyl is unsubstituted or substituted with 1 to 2
R6 groups;
R2 is pyrrolidinyl; wherein said pyrrolidinyl is substituted with one R7 group;
R3 is selected from hydrogen and halo;
R4 is selected from -SF5 and -Y2-CF2-Y3;
R6 at each occurrence is independently selected from hydrogen, hydroxy, methyl, methoxy,
cyano, trifluoromethyl, hydroxy-methyl, halo, amino, fluoro-ethyl, ethyl and cyclopropyl;
R7 is selected from hydroxy, methyl, halo, methoxy, hydroxy-methyl, amino, methyl-amino,
amino-methyl, trifluoromethyl, 2-hydroxypropan-2-yl, methyl-carbonyl-amino, dimethyl-amino,
2-amino-3-methylbutanoyl)oxy, carboxy, methoxy-carbonyl, phosphonooxy, cyano and amino-carbonyl;
Y is selected from CH and N;
Y1 is selected from CH and N;
Y2 is selected from CF2, O and S(O)0-2; and
Y3 is selected from hydrogen, chloro, fluoro, methyl, difluoromethyl and trifluoromethyl.
[0010] In a second aspect, the present invention provides a pharmaceutical composition which
contains a compound of formula (I) or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof,
in admixture with one or more suitable excipients.
[0011] The compounds of formula I are for use in therapy in an animal in which BCR-ABL1
activity contributes to the pathology and/or symptomology of the disease.
[0012] Disclosed is a process for preparing compounds of formula (I), and the pharmaceutically
acceptable salts thereof.
BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
[0013]
Figure 1: X-ray powder diffraction pattern (using a copper source (lambda = 1.54A)
for the measurement) for an amorphous solid dispersion formulation of Example 9 (see
Example 41) having a 25% loading of Example 9 with PVP VA64 (37.5%) and Pharmacoat
603 (37.5%).
Figure 2: Animals with subcutaneous KCL-22 xenografts received daily treatment with
Example 9. Dose-dependent antitumor activity was demonstrated.
Figure 3: KCL-22 cells were grown as sub-cutaneous xenografts and four animals were
dosed with 75mg/kg Nilotinib BID (twice daily). When tumors developed resistance to
treatment with Nilotinib the dosing was changed to 30mg/kg Example 9 BID. The treatment
of nilotinib resistant tumors with Example 9 led to regression of the tumors. Each
line represents a separate animal.
Figure 4 : Animals with subcutaneous KCL-22 xenografts were dosed with a combination
of 30mg/kg Example 9 BID and 75mg/kg Nilotinib BID. Each line represents a separate
animal. Complete tumor regression was seen in all animals and was maintained to the
end of the study.
Definitions
[0014] The general terms used hereinbefore and hereinafter preferably have within the context
of this disclosure the following meanings, unless otherwise indicated, where more
general terms whereever used may, independently of each other, be replaced by more
specific definitions or remain, thus defining more detailed embodiments of the invention:
"Alkyl" refers to branched or unbranched hydrocarbon moieties having 1 to 7 carbon
atoms (C
1-7alkyl), or 1 to 4 carbon atoms (C
1-4alkyl). Representative examples of alkyl include, but are not limited to, methyl,
ethyl,
n-propyl,
iso-propyl,
n-butyl,
sec-butyl,
iso-butyl,
tert-butyl,
n-pentyl, isopentyl, neopentyl,
n-hexyl, 3-methylhexyl, 2,2- dimethylpentyl, 2,3-dimethylpentyl,
n-heptyl,
n-octyl,
n-nonyl,
n-decyl and the like. A substituted alkyl is an alkyl group containing one or more,
such as one, two or three substituents selected from halogen, hydroxy or alkoxy groups.
Halo-substituted-alkyl and halo-substituted-alkoxy, can be either straight-chained
or branched and includes, methoxy, ethoxy, difluoromethyl, trifluoromethyl, pentafluoroethyl,
difluoromethoxy, trifluoromethoxy, and the like.
[0015] "Aryl" means a monocyclic or fused bicyclic aromatic ring assembly containing six
to ten ring carbon atoms. For example, aryl may be phenyl or naphthyl, preferably
phenyl. "Arylene" means a divalent radical derived from an aryl group.
[0016] "BCR-ABL1" refers to a fusion protein created from the
N-terminal exons of the breakpoint cluster region (
BCR) gene and the major C-terminal part (exons 2-11) of the Abelson (
ABL1) gene. The most common fusion transcripts encode for a 210-kDa protein (p210 BCR-ABL1),
although rarer tanscripts encode a 190-kDa protein (p190 BCR-ABL1) and a 230-kDa protein
(p230 BCR-ABL1). The ABL1 sequences of these proteins contains an ABL1 tyrosine kinase
domain which is tightly regulated in the wild-type protein, but constitutively activated
in the BCR-ABL1 fusion proteins. This deregulated tyrosine kinase interacts with multiple
cellular signalling pathways leading to transformation and deregulated proliferation
of the cells.
[0017] "BCR-ABL1 mutants" refers to the numerous single site mutations in BCR-ABL1 including:
Glu255→Lysine, Glu255→Valine, Thr315→Isoleucine, Met244→Val, Phe317→Leu, Leu248→Val,
Met343→Thr, Gly250→Ala, Met351→Thr, Gly250→Glu, Glu355→Gly, Gln252→His, Phe358→Ala,
Gln252→Arg, Phe359→Val, Tyr253→His, Val379→Ile, Tyr253→Phe, Phe382→Leu, Glu255→Lys,
Leu387→Met, Glu255→Val, His396→Pro, Phe311→Ile, His396→Arg, Phe311→Leu, Ser417→Tyr,
Thr315→Ile, Glu459→Lys and Phe486-→Ser.
[0018] Compounds of the invention are sensitive to substitution on the R
3 / R
4 substituted ring at the position that is ortho to the point of attachment of the
NHC(O) group. Compare, for example, the following compounds of formula (I). The IC
50 of Example 2 is 1nM compared to a chloro or methyl substitution whith an IC
50 of 1.6 and 1.8µM, respectively:

|
Caliper ABL1 (64-515) IC50 [µM] |
| Compounds of formula (I) |

|
0.001 |
| Example 2 |

|
1.6 |

|
1.8 |
[0019] "Halogen" (or halo) preferably represents chloro or fluoro, but may also be bromo
or iodo.
[0020] GLEEVEC® (imatinib mesylates) is indicated for the treatment of patients with KIT
(CD117)-positive unresectable and/or metastatic malignant gastrointestinal stromal
tumors (GIST). It is also indicated to treat adult patients following complete gross
resection of KIT (CD117)-positive GIST. It is also indicated for the treatment of
newly diagnosed adult and pediatric patients with Philadelphia chromosome-positive
chronic myeloid leukemia (Ph+ CML) in the chronic phase and patients with Ph+ CML
in blast crisis (BC), accelerated phase (AP), or in the chronic phase (CP) after failure
of interferon-alpha therapy. It can also be used as a targeted medicine for the treatment
of the following rare disorders with limited treatment options: relapsed or refractory
Philadelphia chromosome-positive acute lymphoblastic leukemia (Ph+ ALL); myelodysplastic/myeloproliferative
diseases (MDS/MPD) associated with platelet-derived growth factor receptor (PDGFR)
gene rearrangements; aggressive systemic mastocytosis (ASM) without the D816V c-KIT
mutation or with c-KIT mutational status unknown; hypereosinophilic syndrome/chronic
eosinophilic leukemia (HES/CEL) with the FIP1L1-PDGFRα fusion kinase (mutational analysis
or FISH demonstration of CHIC2 allele deletion) and for patients with HES and/or CEL
who are FIP1L1-PDGFRα fusion kinase negative or unknown ; and unresectable, recurrent,
and/or metastatic dermatofibrosarcoma protuberans (DFSP).
[0021] TASIGNA® (nilotinib) is indicated for the treatment of adult patients with newly
diagnosed Philadelphia chromosome-positive chronic myeloid leukemia (Ph+ CML) in chronic
phase It can be used to treat adults who are no longer benefiting from, or are intolerant
to other treatments, including imatinib (GLEEVEC®), or have taken other treatments,
including imatinib (GLEEVEC) but cannot tolerate them.
[0022] SPRYCEL® (dasatinib) is a prescription medicine used to treat adults who have newly
diagnosed Philadelphia chromosome-positive (Ph+) chronic myeloid leukemia (CML) in
chronic phase and to treat adults who are no longer benefitting or are intolerant
to other treatments, as well as for patients with ALL.
[0023] BOSULIF® (Bosutinib) is a prescription medicine used to treat adults who have newly
diagnosed Philadelphia chromosome-positive (Ph+) chronic myeloid leukemia (CML) in
chronic phase and to treat adults who are no longer benefitting or are intolerant
to other treatments, as well as for patients with ALL.
[0024] Compounds of formula (I) may have different isomeric forms. For example, any asymmetric
carbon atom may be present in the (R)-, (S)- or (R,S)-configuration, preferably in
the (R)- or (S)-configuration. Substituents at a double bond or especially a ring
may be present in cis-(= Z-) or trans (= E-) form. The compounds may thus be present
as mixtures of isomers or preferably pure isomers, preferably as pure diastereomers
or pure enantiomers. The following compounds of formula (I) would exist in tautomeric
form:

[0025] To illustrate tautomerism with the following specific examples, (R)-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(right structure, below) is a tautomer of (R)-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-3-yl)nicotinamide
(left structure, below) and vice versa:

[0026] Where the plural form (
e.g. compounds, salts) is used, this includes the singular (
e.g. a single compound, a single salt). "A compound" does not exclude that (
e.g. in a pharmaceutical formulation) more than one compound of the formula (I) (or a
salt thereof) is present, the "a" merely representing the indefinite article. "A"
can thus preferably be read as "one or more", less preferably alternatively as "one".
[0027] Any formulae given herein is also intended to represent unlabeled forms as well as
isotopically labeled forms of the compounds. Isotopically labeled compounds have structures
depicted by the formulae given herein except that one or more atoms are replaced by
an atom having a selected atomic mass or mass number. Examples of isotopes that can
be incorporated into compounds of the invention include isotopes of hydrogen, carbon,
nitrogen, oxygen, phosphorous, fluorine, and chlorine, such as
2H,
3H,
11C,
13C,
14C,
15N,
18F
31P,
32P,
35S,
36Cl,
123I,
124I,
125I respectively. The invention includes various isotopically labeled compounds as defined
herein, for example those into which radioactive isotopes, such as
3H and
14C, or those into which non-radioactive isotopes, such as
2H and
13C are present. Such isotopically labelled compounds are useful in metabolic studies
(with
14C), reaction kinetic studies (with, for example
2H or
3H), detection or imaging techniques, such as positron emission tomography (PET) or
single-photon emission computed tomography (SPECT) including drug or substrate tissue
distribution assays, or in radioactive treatment of patients. In particular, an
18F or labeled compound may be particularly desirable for PET or SPECT studies. Isotopically-labeled
compounds of the invention can generally be prepared by conventional techniques known
to those skilled in the art or by processes analogous to those described in the accompanying
Examples using appropriate isotopically-labeled reagents.
[0028] Further, substitution with heavier isotopes, particularly deuterium (i.e.,
2H or D) may afford certain therapeutic advantages resulting from greater metabolic
stability, for example increased in vivo half-life or reduced dosage requirements
or an improvement in therapeutic index. It is understood that deuterium in this context
is regarded as a substituent of a compound of the invention. The concentration of
such a heavier isotope, specifically deuterium, may be defined by the isotopic enrichment
factor. The term "isotopic enrichment factor" as used herein means the ratio between
the isotopic abundance and the natural abundance of a specified isotope. If a substituent
in a compound of this invention is denoted deuterium, such compound has an isotopic
enrichment factor for each designated deuterium atom of at least 3500 (52.5% deuterium
incorporation at each designated deuterium atom), at least 4000 (60% deuterium incorporation),
at least 4500 (67.5% deuterium incorporation), at least 5000 (75% deuterium incorporation),
at least 5500 (82.5% deuterium incorporation), at least 6000 (90% deuterium incorporation),
at least 6333.3 (95% deuterium incorporation), at least 6466.7 (97% deuterium incorporation),
at least 6600 (99% deuterium incorporation), or at least 6633.3 (99.5% deuterium incorporation).
[0029] For example, a compound of formula Ib, shown here where R
3 is hydrogen and Y is CH, can incorporate deuterium on the pyrrolidinyl ring as shown:

[0030] This deuterated form is less prone to metabolic transformation (left, above) compared
with the none deuterated form (right, above).
Description of Preferred Embodiments
[0031] The present invention relates to compounds capable of inhibiting the activity of
BCR-ABL1 or mutants of BCR-ABL1 through the allosteric, myristoyl binding site.
[0032] In one embodiment, with respect to compounds of the invention, are compounds of formula
(Ib):

in which: R
3 is selected from hydrogen and halo; R
4 is selected from -SF
5 and -Y
2-CF
2-Y
3; R
6 when linked to a nitrogen of the pyrazolyl ring is selected from hydrogen, methyl,
hydroxy-ethyl, fluoro-ethyl, ethyl and cyclopropyl; and R
6 when linked to a carbon atom of the pyrazolyl ring is selected from hydrogen, hydroxy,
methyl, methoxy, cyano, trifluoromethyl, hydroxy-methyl, halo, amino, fluoro-ethyl,
ethyl and cyclopropyl; R
7 is selected from hydroxy, methyl, halo, methoxy, hydroxy-methyl, amino, methyl-amino,
amino-methyl, trifluoromethyl, 2-hydroxypropan-2-yl, methyl-carbonyl-amino, dimethyl-amino,
2-amino-3-methylbutanoyl)oxy, carboxy, methoxy-carbonyl, phosphonooxy, cyano and amino-carbonyl;
Y
1 is selected from CH and N; Y
2 is selected from CF
2, O and S(O)
0-2; Y
3 is selected from hydrogen, fluoro, chloro, methyl, difluoromethyl and trifluoromethyl;
or the pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof.
[0033] In a further embodiment are compounds of formula (Ic):

in which: R
3 is selected from hydrogen and halo; R
4 is selected from -SF
5 and -Y
2-CF
2-Y
3; R
6 when linked to a nitrogen of the pyrazolyl ring is selected from hydrogen, methyl,
hydroxy-ethyl, fluoro-ethyl, ethyl and cyclopropyl; and R
6 when linked to a carbon atom of the pyrazolyl ring is selected from hydrogen, hydroxy,
methyl, methoxy, cyano, trifluoromethyl, hydroxy-methyl, halo, amino, fluoro-ethyl,
ethyl and cyclopropyl; R
7 is selected from hydroxy, methyl, halo, methoxy, hydroxy-methyl, amino, methyl-amino,
amino-methyl, trifluoromethyl, 2-hydroxypropan-2-yl, methyl-carbonyl-amino, dimethyl-amino,
2-amino-3-methylbutanoyl)oxy, carboxy, methoxy-carbonyl, phosphonooxy, cyano and amino-carbonyl;
Y
1 is selected from CH and N; Y
2 is selected from CF
2, O and S(O)
0-2; Y
3 is selected from hydrogen, fluoro, chloro, methyl, difluoromethyl and trifluoromethyl;
or the pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof.
[0034] In another embodiment are compounds of formula (I), or the pharmaceutically acceptable
salts thereof, in which R
1 is pyrazolyl; wherein said pyrazolyl is unsubstituted or substituted with 1 to 2
R
6 groups.
[0035] In a further embodiment, R
1 is an unsubstituted pyrazolyl.
[0036] In a further embodiment, R
1 is pyrazolyl substituted with one R
6 group.
[0037] In a further embodiment, R
1 is pyrazolyl substituted with two R
6 groups.
[0038] In another embodiment, R
2 is pyrrolidin-1-yl substituted with one R
7 group.
[0039] In another embodiment, Y is selected from CH and N.
[0040] In a further embodiment, Y is N.
[0041] In a further embodiment, Y is CH.
[0042] In another mbodiment, Y
1 is selected from CH and N.
[0043] In a further embodiment, Y
1 is N.
[0044] In a further embodiment, Y
1 is CH.
[0045] The following further embodiments apply to compounds of any one of formulae (I),
(Ib) or (Ic), or the pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof.
[0046] In another embodiment, R
3 is selected from hydrogen and halo.
[0047] In another embodiment, R
4 is selected from -SF
5 and -Y
2-CF
2-Y
3.
[0048] In a further embodiment, R
4 is chlorodifluoromethoxy.
[0049] In a further embodiment, R
4 is trifluoromethoxy.
[0050] In another embodiment, R
6 at each occurrence is independently selected from hydrogen, hydroxy, methyl, methoxy,
cyano, trifluoromethyl, hydroxy-methyl, halo, amino, fluoro-ethyl, ethyl and cyclopropyl.
[0051] In a further embodiment, R
6, when linked to a nitrogen of the pyrazolyl ring, is selected from hydrogen, methyl,
hydroxy-ethyl, fluoro-ethyl, ethyl and cyclopropyl.
[0052] In a further embodiment, R
6, when linked to a carbon atom of the pyrazolyl ring, is selected from hydrogen, hydroxy,
methyl, methoxy, cyano, trifluoromethyl, hydroxy-methyl, halo, amino, fluoro-ethyl,
ethyl and cyclopropyl.
[0053] In another embodiment, R
7 is selected from hydroxy, methyl, halo, methoxy, hydroxy-methyl, amino, methyl-amino,
amino-methyl, trifluoromethyl, 2-hydroxypropan-2-yl, methyl-carbonyl-amino, dimethyl-amino,
2-amino-3-methylbutanoyl)oxy, carboxy, methoxy-carbonyl, phosphonooxy, cyano and amino-carbonyl.
[0054] In another embodiment, Y
2 is selected from CF
2, O and S(O)
0-2.
[0055] In a further embodiment, Y
2 is O.
[0056] In a further embodiment, Y
2 is CF
2.
[0057] In a further embodiment, Y
2 is S(O)
0-2.
[0058] In another embodiment, Y
3 is selected from hydrogen, chloro, fluoro, methyl, difluoromethyl and trifluoromethyl.
[0059] In a further embodiment, Y
3 is chloro.
[0060] In a further embodiment, Y
3 is fluoro.
[0061] In a further embodiment are compounds, or the pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof,
selected from:

[0063] In another embodiment are compounds, or the pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof,
selected from:

[0064] In another embodiment is a compound, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof,
that is:

[0065] In another embodiment are compounds selected from:

Pharmacology and Utility
[0066] On the basis of the inhibitory studies described in the "Assay" section below, a
compound of formula (I) according to the invention shows therapeutic efficacy especially
against disorders dependent on BCR-ABL1 activity. In particular, compounds of the
present invention inhibit the allosteric or myristoyl binding site of BCR-ABL1 (including
wild-type BCR-ABL1 and/or mutations thereof).
[0067] Combining an ATP-competitive inhibitor of BCR-ABL1 with an allosteric inhibitor of
BCR-ABL1 delays acquired resistance in BCR-ABL1+KCL-22 cells,
in vitro. Surprisingly, BCR-ABL1+KCL-22 cells treated every 3-4 days with a compound of the
invention showed an acquired resistance after approximately 28 days whereas these
same cells treated every 3-4 days with nilotinib or dasatinib showed an acquired resistance
after only 18-21 days. Even more surprisingly, when BCR-ABL1+KCL-22 cells were treated
every 3-4 days with a combination of a compound of the invention and either nilotinib
or dasatinib, no acquired resistance was observed in at least the first 60 days. Therefore,
myristoyl-binding site compounds of the present invention, in combination with BCR-ABL1
inhibitors that bind to the ATP binding site are especially important for the treatment
of proliferative diseases involving upregulation of ABL1 kinase activity, as in the
case of BCR-ABL1 fusion proteins in CML and subsets of other haematological malignancies
such as ALL and AML.
[0068] Carcinoma cells utilize invapodia to degrade the extra cellular matrix during tumor
invasion and metastasis. ABL kinase activity is required for SRC-induced invapodia
formation, regulating distinct stages of invapodia assembly and function. The compounds
of the invention, therefore, as inhibitors of ABL1, have the potential to be used
as therapies for the treatment of metastatic invasive carcinomas.
[0069] An allosteric inhibitor of ABL1 kinase can be used to treat brain cancers: including
Glioblastoma which is the most common & most aggressive malignant primary brain tumor
in which the expression of ABL1 is immunohistochemically detectable in a subset of
patients (
Haberler C, Gelpi E, Marosi C, Rössler K, Birner P, Budka H, Hainfellner JA. Immunohistochemical
analysis of platelet-derived growth factor receptor-alpha, -beta, c-KIT, ABL1, and
ABL2 proteins in glioblastoma: possible implications for patient selection for imatinib
mesylate therapy. J Neurooncol. 2006 Jan;76(2): 105-9). However, clinical trials with Gleevec® failed in patients with glioblastoma (
Reardon DA, Dresemann G, Taillibert S, Campone M, van den Bent M, Clement P, Blomquist
E, Gordower L, Schultz H, Raizer J, Hau P, Easaw J, Gil M, Tonn J, Gijtenbeek A, Schlegel
U, Bergstrom P, Green S, Weir A, Nikolova Z. Multicentre phase II studies evaluating
imatinib plus hydroxyurea in patients with progressive glioblastoma. Br J Cancer.
2009 Dec 15;101(12): 1995-2004;
Razis E, Selviaridis P, Labropoulos S, Norris JL, Zhu MJ, Song DD, Kalebic T, Torrens
M, Kalogera-Fountzila A, Karkavelas G, Karanastasi S, Fletcher JA, Fountzilas G. Phase
II study of neoadjuvant imatinib in glioblastoma: evaluation of clinical and molecular
effects of the treatment. Clin Cancer Res. 2009 Oct 1;15(19):6258-66;
Dresemann G. Imatinib and hydroxyurea in pretreated progressive glioblastoma multiforme:
a patient series. Ann Oncol. 2005 Oct;16(10):1702-8), possibly because of the poor brain intratumoral exposure of the drug and in the
absence of disturbed blood-brain barrier (
Holdhoff et al, J Neurooncol. 2010;97(2):241-5). The transport of Gleevec® across the blood-brain barrier is in fact shown in preclinical
studies to be limited by active efflux transporters such as P-glycoprotein. This is
also the case for dasatinib (
Chen Y, Agarwal S, Shaik NM, Chen C, Yang Z, Elmquist WF. P-glycoprotein and breast
cancer resistance protein influence brain distribution of dasatinib. J Pharmacol Exp
Ther. 2009 Sep;330(3):956-63). Irradiation is known to enhance the blood-brain barrier opening. In mouse models,
glioblastoma multiforme response to Gleevec® correlated with an increase in tumor
growth delay and survival when Gleevec® was administered in conjunction with daily
irradiation (
Geng L, Shinohara ET, Kim D, Tan J, Osusky K, Shyr Y, Hallahan DE. STI571 (Gleevec)
improves tumor growth delay and survival in irradiated mouse models of glioblastoma.
Int J Radiat Oncol Biol Phys. 2006 Jan 1;64(1):263-71). Therefore a new ABL1 inhibitor with high brain exposure represents a solid therapeutic
approach for glioblastoma and other brain cancers.
[0070] CNS-CML: In some CML patients treated with Gleevec®, CNS Blast crisis and failure
have been reported and can be explained by the poor brain exposure of Gleevec®. (
Kim HJ, Jung CW, Kim K, Ahn JS, Kim WS, Park K, Ko YH, Kang WK, Park K. Isolated blast
crisis in CNS in a patient with chronic myelogenous leukemia maintaining major cytogenetic
response after imatinib. J Clin Oncol. 2006 Aug 20;24(24):4028-9;
Radhika N, Minakshi M, Rajesh M, Manas BR, Deepak Kumar M.Central nervous system blast
crisis in chronic myeloid leukemia on imatinib mesylate therapy: report of two cases.
Indian J Hematol Blood Transfus. 2011 Mar;27(1):51-4). In fact, in CML patients, Gleevec®'s concentration is in fact much lower (∼100
fold) in the CNS than in plasma (
Leis JF, Stepan DE, Curtin PT, Ford JM, Peng B, Schubach S, Druker BJ, Maziarz RT.
Central nervous system failure in patients with chronic myelogenous leukemia lymphoid
blast crisis and Philadelphia chromosome positive acute lymphoblastic leukemia treated
with imatinib (STI-571). Leuk Lymphoma. 2004 Apr;45(4):695-8). Therefore, ABL1 inhibitors from the present invention which show a high brain exposure
represent a valid approach for development of therapies against CML including CNS-CML.
[0071] Compounds of the invention can be useful in the treatment of viruses. For example,
viral infections can be mediated by ABL1 kinase activity, as in the case of pox-viruses
and the Ebola virus. Gleevec® and Tasigna® have been shown to stop the release of
Ebola viral particles from infected cells,
in vitro (Kalman, Daniel; Bornmann, William Gerard, Methods of use of non-ATP competitive
tyrosine kinase inhibitors to treat pathogenic infection,
PCT Int. Appl. 2007, WO 2007002441;
Garcia Mayra; Cooper Arik; Shi Wei; Bornmann William; Carrion Ricardo; Kalman Daniel;
Nabel Gary J. Productive Replication of Ebola Virus Is Regulated by the ABL1 Tyrosine
Kinase. Science translational medicine 2012;4:123ra24). Compounds of the present invention that inhibit ABL1 kinase, therefore, can be
expected to reduce the pathogen's ability to replicate.
[0072] Compounds of the invention can also be useful in the treatment of neural degeneration.
While native ABL1 tyrosine kinase remains relatively quiescent in healthy adult brain,
it can be activated in the brain of patients with CNS diseases, including neurodegenerative
diseases such as, Alzheimer's disease (AD), Parkinson's disease (AD), frontotemporal
dementia (FTD), Picks disease, Niemann-Pick type C disease (NPC) and other degenerative,
inflammatory and autoimmune diseases and ageing.
[0073] Parkinson's disease is the second most prevalent chronic neurodegenerative disease
with the most common familial autosomal-recessive form being caused by mutations in
the E3 ubiquitin ligase, parkin. Recent studies showed that activated ABL1/ABL2 was
found in the striatum of patients with sporadic Parkinson's disease. Concomitantly,
parkin was tyrosine-phosphorylated, causing loss of its ubiquitin ligase and cytoprotective
activities as indicated by the accumulation of parkin substrates (
Ko HS, Lee Y, Shin JH, Karuppagounder SS, Gadad BS, Koleske AJ, Pletnikova O, Troncoso
JC, Dawson VL, Dawson TM. Phosphorylation by the c-Abl protein tyrosine kinase inhibits
parkin's ubiquitination and protective function. Proc Natl Acad Sci U S A. 2010 Sep
21;107(38):16691-6;
Imam SZ, Zhou Q, Yamamoto A, Valente AJ, Ali SF, Bains M, Roberts JL, Kahle PJ, Clark
RA, Li S. Novel regulation of parkin function through c-Abl-mediated tyrosine phosphorylation:
implications for Parkinson's disease. J Neurosci. 2011 Jan 5;31(1):157-63). These two studies also showed that in cell or animal models of Parkinson's disease,
pharmacological inhibition of ABL1 kinase or genetic ABL1 knockdown prevented tyrosine
phosphorylation of parkin and restored its E3 ligase activity and cytoprotective function
both
in vitro and
in vivo. These results indicate that ABL1-dependent tyrosine phosphorylation of parkin is
a major post-translational modification that leads to loss of parkin function and
disease progression in sporadic PD. Therefore, the ability of compounds of the invention
to inhibit the myristate-binding site of ABL1, can be expected to offer new therapeutic
opportunities for blocking the progression of Parkinson's disease.
[0074] Alzheimer's disease is characterized by two main hallmarks: extracellular deposits
of the neurotoxic amyloid-β which leads to amyloid plaque development, and intracellular
accumulation of hyperphosphorylated tau which contributes to the development of neurofibrillary
tangles (NFTs).
[0075] Amyloid-β level is reduced following intrathecal treatment with Gleevec® in the brain
of wild-type guinea-pigs and in cell models (
Netzer WJ, Dou F, Cai D, Veach D, Jean S, Li Y, Bornmann WG, Clarkson B, Xu H, Greengard
P. Gleevec inhibits beta-amyloid production but not Notch cleavage. Proc Natl Acad
Sci U S A. 2003 Oct 14;100(21):12444-9). The same group proposed that Gleevec® achieves its amyloid-β-lowering effect via
a new mechanism preventing GSAP interaction with the gamma-secretase substrate, APP-CTF
(
He G, Luo W, Li P, Remmers C, Netzer WJ, Hendrick J, Bettayeb K, Flajolet M, Gorelick
F, Wennogle LP, Greengard P. Gamma-secretase activating protein is a therapeutic target
for Alzheimer's disease. Nature. 2010 Sep 2;467(7311):95-8). In this study, Gleevec®'s effect to inhibit GSAP/APP-CTF was only seen at micromolar
concentrations. Another group showed that tyrosine phosphorylation of the intracellular
domain of APP (i.e. Tyr682) regulates the amyloidogenic APP processing accelerating
amyloid-β formation in vivo (
Barbagallo AP, Weldon R, Tamayev R, Zhou D, Giliberto L, Foreman O, D'Adamio L. Tyr(682)
in the intracellular domain of APP regulates amyloidogenic APP processing in vivo.
PLoS One. 2010 Nov 16;5(11):e15503). Other studies showed that APP is tyrosine-phosphorylated in cells expressing a
constitutively active form of the ABL1 oncogene (
Zambrano N, Bruni P, Minopoli G, Mosca R, Molino D, Russo C, Schettini G, Sudol M,
Russo T. The beta-amyloid precursor protein APP is tyrosine-phosphorylated in cells
expressing a constitutively active form of the Abl protoncogene. J Biol Chem. 2001
Jun 8;276(23):19787-92). These data together suggest an ABL1-dependent amyloidogenic APP processing for
the formation of the toxic amyloid-β peptide and subsequent amyloid plaques. Therefore
an-ABL1 inhibitor would be expected to lower amyloid plaque formation in Alzheimmer's
patients.
[0076] Tau has been shown to be phosphorylated by ABL1 kinase at tyrosines 18, 197, 310,
and 394 in cell models, and tau pY394 has been shown to be present in the lesions
NFTs in the brain of AD patients.
[0077] ABL1 is activated in the brain of patients with sporadic Alzheimer's disease as shown
by its phosphorylation either at Y412, an indicator of activation, which co-localizes
granulovacuolar degeneration, or at T735 which co-localized with the typical lesions,
amyloid plaques, neurofibrillary tangles (NFTs) in addition to GVD. Amyloid-β and
oxidative stress activate ABL1 kinase in neuronal cultures and intracerebral injection
of fibrillar amyloid peptide leads to increased expression of ABL1 and a downstream
effector p73. Transgenic mice (APP/Swe mouse model of AD), showed higher levels of
ABL1 in their brain and, when these mice were treated with the ABL1 inhibitor Gleevec®,
tau phosphorylation was decreased in their brains. A transgenic mouse model expressing
constitutively active ABL1 in forebrain neurons exhibited neuronal loss, severe neuroinflammation,
and tyrosine phosphorylation of tau in the brain (For review, see
Schlatterer SD, Acker CM, Davies P. c-Abl in neurodegenerative disease. J Mol Neurosci.
2011 Nov;45(3):445-52).
[0078] Based on all these results, evidence exists for a role for ABL1 kinase in Alzheimer's
pathogenesis for development of both lesions, amyloid plaques and neurofibrillary
tangles.
[0080] Therefore, compounds of the present invention, by inhibiting ABL1 in the CNS, represent
a valid approach for development of therapies against Alzheimer's disease, as well
as other β-amyloidoses, such as vascular dementia and other tauopathies, such as frontotemporal
dementia and picks disease.
[0081] Niemann-Pick type C (NPC) disease is a fatal autosomal recessive disorder characterized
by the accumulation of free cholesterol and glycosphingolipids in the endosomal-lysosomal
system, and by a progressive neuronal death in particular of cerebellar Purkinje neurons.
In a mouse model of NPC, the proapoptotic ABL1, the downstream target as well as p73
target genes are expressed in the cerebellums. Inhibition of ABL1 with Gleevec® prevented
from loss of Purkinje neurons, improved neurological symptoms, and increased the survival.
This prosurvival effect of Gleevec® correlated with reduced mRNA levels of p73 proapoptotic
target genes (
Alvarez AR, Klein A, Castro J, Cancino GI, Amigo J, Mosqueira M, Vargas LM, Yévenes
LF, Bronfman FC, Zanlungo S. Imatinib therapy blocks cerebellar apoptosis and improves
neurological symptoms in a mouse model of Niemann-Pick type C disease. FASEB J. 2008
Oct;22(10):3617-27). Therefore, compounds of the present invention, by inhibiting ABL1 kinase, represent
a valid approach for the development of therapies against diseases caused by the proapoptotic
ABL1/p73 pathway, such as NPC.
[0082] In prion disease models, Gleevec® showed beneficial effects: It delayed prion neuroinvasion
by inhibiting prion propagation from the periphery to the CNS (
Yun SW, Ertmer A, Flechsig E, Gilch S, Riederer P, Gerlach M, Schätzl HM, Klein MA.
The tyrosine kinase inhibitor imatinib mesylate delays prion neuroinvasion by inhibiting
prion propagation in the periphery. J Neurovirol. 2007 Aug;13(4):328-37). Gleevec® and ABL1 deficiency induced cellular clearance of PrPSc in prion-infected
cells (
Ertmer A, Gilch S, Yun SW, Flechsig E, Klebl B, Stein-Gerlach M, Klein MA, Schätzl
HM. The tyrosine kinase inhibitor STI571 induces cellular clearance of PrPSc in prion-infected
cells. J Biol Chem. 2004 Oct 1;279(40):41918-27). Therefore, novel ABL1 inhibitors from the present invention also represent a valid
therapeutic approach for the treatment of prion diseases such as Creutzfeldt-Jacob
disease.
[0083] X-linked recessive Emery-Dreifuss muscular dystrophy is caused by mutations of emerin,
a nuclear-membrane protein with roles in nuclear architecture, gene regulation and
signaling. A recent study has shown that emerin is tyrosine-phosphorylated directly
by ABL1 in cell models, and that the phosphorylation status of emerin changes emerin
binding to other proteins such as BAF. This, in turn, may explain the mislocalization
of mutant emerin from nuclear to cytosolic compartments and consequently changes in
downstream effector and signal integrator for signaling pathway(s) at the nuclear
envelope (
Tifft KE, Bradbury KA, Wilson KL. Tyrosine phosphorylation of nuclear-membrane protein
emerin by SRC, ABL1 and other kinases. J Cell Sci. 2009 Oct 15;122(Pt 20):3780-90). Changes in emerin-lamin interactions during both mitosis and interphase are of
relevance for the pathology of muscular dystrophies. In addition, results from another
study demonstrate that Gleevec® attenuates skeletal muscle dystrophy in mdx mice (
Huang P, Zhao XS, Fields M, Ransohoff RM, Zhou L. Imatinib attenuates skeletal muscle
dystrophy in mdx mice. FASEB J. 2009 Aug;23(8):2539-48).
[0084] Therefore, novel ABL1 inhibitors from the present invention also represent therapeutic
approaches for treatment of skeletal and muscular dystrophies.
[0085] Furthermore, ABL1 kinase plays a role in inflammation and oxidative stress, two mechanisms
that are implicated in a variety of human diseases ranging from acute CNS diseases,
such as stroke and traumatic brain or spinal cord injuries, chronic CNS diseases,
such as Alzheimer's, Parkinson's, Huntington's and motoneuron diseases, to non-CNS
inflammatory and autoimmune diseases, such as diabetes, pulmonary fibrosis.
[0086] For example, Gleevec® prevents fibrosis in different preclinical models of systemic
sclerosis and induces regression of established fibrosis (
Akhmetshina A, Venalis P, Dees C, Busch N, Zwerina J, Schett G, Distler O, Distler
JH. Treatment with imatinib prevents fibrosis in different preclinical models of systemic
sclerosis and induces regression of established fibrosis. Arthritis Rheum. 2009 Jan;60(1):219-24) and it shows antifibrotic effects in bleomycin-induced pulmonary fibrosis in mice
(
Aono Y, Nishioka Y, Inayama M, Ugai M, Kishi J, Uehara H, Izumi K, Sone S. Imatinib
as a novel antifibrotic agent in bleomycin-induced pulmonary fibrosis in mice. Am
J Respir Crit Care Med. 2005 Jun 1;171(11):1279-85). Another study showed that both imatinib and nilotinib attenuated bleomycin-induced
acute lung injury and pulmonary fibrosis in mice (
Rhee CK, Lee SH, Yoon HK, Kim SC, Lee SY, Kwon SS, Kim YK, Kim KH, Kim TJ, Kim JW.
Effect of nilotinib on bleomycin-induced acute lung injury and pulmonary fibrosis
in mice. Respiration. 2011;82(3):273-87). Although in these studies the authors were focusing on the implication the mechanism
related to PDGFRs, of interest, in the study by
Rhee et al. (Respiration. 2011;82(3):273-87), nilotinib which is a more potent c-ABL inhibitor than imatinib showed superior
therapeutic antifibrotic effects, thus supporting the therapeutic applicability of
c-ABL inhibitors for treatment of human diseases with pulmonary inflammation. In another
study, exposure of mice to hyperoxia increased ABL1 activation which is required for
dynamin 2 phosphorylation and reactive oxygen species production and pulmonary leak
(
Singleton PA, Pendyala S, Gorshkova IA, Mambetsariev N, Moitra J, Garcia JG, Natarajan
V. Dynamin 2 and c-Abl are novel regulators of hyperoxia-mediated NADPH oxidase activation
and reactive oxygen species production in caveolin-enriched microdomains of the endothelium.
J Biol Chem. 2009 Dec 11;284(50):34964-75).
[0087] Therefore, these data indicate that new c-ABL inhibitors from the present invention
have therapeutic applicability for treatment of human diseases with pulmonary inflammation.
[0088] ABL1 activation by insulin, via a modification of FAK response, may play an important
role in directing mitogenic versus metabolic insulin receptor signaling (
Genua M, Pandini G, Cassarino MF, Messina RL, Frasca F. c-Abl and insulin receptor
signalling. Vitam Horm. 2009;80:77-105). c-Abl inhibitors such as Gleevec® have been shown to reverse type 1 diabetes in
nonobese diabetic mice (
Louvet C, Szot GL, Lang J, Lee MR, Martinier N, Bollag G, Zhu S, Weiss A, Bluestone
JA. Tyrosine kinase inhibitors reverse type 1 diabetes in nonobese diabetic mice.
Proc Natl Acad Sci U S A. 2008 Dec 2;105(48):18895-900). Amelioration of diabetes by Gleevec® was mimicked by siRNA-mediated knockdown of
ABL1 mRNA (
Hägerkvist R, Sandler S, Mokhtari D, Welsh N. Amelioration of diabetes by imatinib
mesylate (Gleevec): role of beta-cell NF-kappaB activation and anti-apoptotic preconditioning.
FASEB J. 2007 Feb;21(2):618-28).
[0089] Therefore, the new ABL1 inhibitors from the present invention have therapeutic applicability
for treatment of human diabetes.
[0090] An ABL1 inhibitor from the present invention can be used in combination with one
or more of the existing treatment for the above diseases: for example an ABL1 inhibitor
from the present invention can be used in combination with Levodopa or other L-DOPA-containing
medicaments or a dopamine agonist for the treatment of Parkinson's disease or in combination
with a cholinesterase inhibitor such as Exelon capsule or transdermal patch for the
treatment of Alzheimer's disease.
[0091] In chronic myelogeous leukemia (CML), a reciprocal balanced chromosomal translocation
in hematopoietic stem cells (HSCs) produces the BCR-ABL1 hybrid gene. The latter encodes
the oncogenic BCR-ABL1 fusion protein. Whereas ABL1 encodes a tightly regulated protein
tyrosine kinase, which plays a fundamental role in regulating cell proliferation,
adherence and apoptosis, the BCR-ABL1 fusion gene encodes as constitutively activated
kinase. This activated kinase transforms HSCs to produce a phenotype exhibiting deregulated
clonal proliferation, reduced capacity to adhere to the bone marrow stroma and a reduced
apoptotic response to mutagenic stimuli, resulting in progressively more malignant
transformations. The resulting granulocytes fail to develop into mature lymphocytes
and are released into the circulation, leading to a deficiency in the mature cells
and increased susceptibility to infection. ATP-competitive inhibitors of BCR-ABL1
have been demonstrated to prevent the kinase from activating mitogenic and anti-apoptotic
pathways (for example, PI-3 kinase and STAT5), leading to the death of the BCR-ABL1
phenotype cells and thereby providing an effective therapy against CML. The KCL-22
cell line (purchased from DSMZ, Leibniz Institute, Germany) is established from the
pleural effusion of a 32-year old woman with Philadelphia chromosome-positive CML
in blast crisis in 1981, and has been described to contain the t(9;22) leading to
BCR-ABL1 fusion gene and a p53 mutation. KCL-22 cell lines can be used in Xenograft
models to show
in vivo efficacy of compounds of the invention (see Assay section,
infra). The compounds of the invention, as BCR-ABL1 inhibitors, including mutants thereof,
are thus especially appropriate for the therapy of diseases related to its over-expression,
such as ALL or CML leukemias.
[0092] Compounds of the invention have also been demonstrated to have anti-tumor activity,
in vitro: The
in vitro antitumor activity is tested, for example using leukemic cell lines such as Ba/F3-BCR-ABL1,
KCL-22, K-562, MEG-01, KYO-1, LAMA-84, KU812, EM-2, CML-Tl, BV-173, or ALL-SIL.
[0093] A compound of the invention or a pharmaceutical composition may be used in a method
to treat cancer, comprising administering to a subject in need of such treatment an
effective amount of a compound of the invention or a pharmaceutical composition.
[0094] An additional therapeutic agent may be administered.
[0095] The additional therapeutic agent may be a different BCR-ABL1 inhibitor selected from
imatinib, nilotinib, dasatinib, dosutinib, radotinib, ponatinib and bafetinib.
[0096] A method to treat a condition mediated by BCR-ABL1, may comprise administering to
a subject in need thereof an effective amount of a compound of the invention or a
pharmaceutical composition.
[0098] A condition mediated by the BCR-ABL1, where the BCR-ABL1 contains one or more mutations
selected from V299L, T315I, F317I, F317L, Y253F, Y253H, E255K, E255V, F359C and F359V,
may be treated.
[0099] The compound may be administered parenterally.
[0100] The compound may be administered intramuscularly, intravenously, subcutaneously,
orally, pulmonary, intrathecally, topically or intranasally.
[0101] The compound may be administered systemically.
[0102] The patient may be a mammal.
[0103] The patient may be a primate.
[0104] The patient may be a human.
[0105] A method of treating an ABL1/BCR-ABL1 -mediated disorder, may comprise the step of:
administering to a patient in need thereof a therapeutically effective amount of a
chemotherapeutic agent in combination with a therapeutically effective amount of a
compound of formula (I).
[0106] In another aspect is a compound of formula I, or any specific embodiments thereof
described above, for use in the treatment of cancer.
[0107] In a further aspect, the cancer is leukemia selected from chronic myeloid leukemia
(CML) and acute lymphoblastic leukemia (ALL).
[0108] In another aspect is a compound of formula I or any specific embodiments thereof
for use in the treatment of cancer in combination with an additional compound selected
from imatinib, nilotinib, dasatinib, bosutinib, ponatinib and bafetinib.
[0109] In a further aspect, the compound of formula I is (R)-N-(4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide.
[0110] In a further aspect the compound of formula I is a pharmaceutically acceptable salt
of (R)-N-(4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide.
[0111] In a further aspect, the additional compound is administered sequentially.
[0112] In a further aspect, the additional compound is administered simultaneously.
[0113] In a further aspect, the additional compound is nilotinib.
[0114] In a further aspect, the additional compound is imatinib.
[0115] In a further aspect, the additional compound is dasatinib.
[0116] In a further aspect, the additional compound is bosutinib.
[0117] In a further aspect, the additional compound is ponatinib.
[0118] In a further aspect, the additional compound is bafetinib.
Pharmaceutical Compositions
[0119] In another aspect, the present invention provides pharmaceutically acceptable compositions
which comprise a therapeutically-effective amount of one or more of the compounds
described above, formulated together with one or more pharmaceutically acceptable
carriers (additives) and/or diluents. As described in detail below, the pharmaceutical
compositions of the present invention may be specially formulated for administration
in solid or liquid form, including those adapted for the following: (1) oral administration,
for example, drenches (aqueous or non-aqueous solutions or suspensions), tablets,
e.g., those targeted for buccal, sublingual, and systemic absorption, boluses, powders,
granules, pastes for application to the tongue; (2) parenteral administration, for
example, by subcutaneous, intramuscular, intravenous or epidural injection as, for
example, a sterile solution or suspension, or sustained-release formulation; (3) topical
application, for example, as a cream, ointment, or a controlled-release patch or spray
applied to the skin; (4) intravaginally or intrarectally, for example, as a pessary,
cream or foam; (5) sublingually; (6) ocularly; (7) transdermally; (8) nasally; (9)
pulmonary; or (10) intrathecally.
[0120] The phrase "therapeutically-effective amount" as used herein means that amount of
a compound, material, or composition comprising a compound of the present invention
which is effective for producing some desired therapeutic effect in at least a sub-population
of cells in an animal at a reasonable benefit/risk ratio applicable to any medical
treatment.
[0121] The phrase "pharmaceutically acceptable" is employed herein to refer to those compounds,
materials, compositions, and/or dosage forms which are, within the scope of sound
medical judgment, suitable for use in contact with the tissues of human beings and
animals without excessive toxicity, irritation, allergic response, or other problem
or complication, commensurate with a reasonable benefit/risk ratio.
[0122] The phrase "pharmaceutically-acceptable carrier" as used herein means a pharmaceutically-acceptable
material, composition or vehicle, such as a liquid or solid filler, diluent, excipient,
manufacturing aid (
e.g., lubricant, talc magnesium, calcium or zinc stearate, or steric acid), or solvent
encapsulating material, involved in carrying or transporting the subject compound
from one organ, or portion of the body, to another organ, or portion of the body.
Each carrier must be "acceptable" in the sense of being compatible with the other
ingredients of the formulation and not injurious to the patient. Some examples of
materials which can serve as pharmaceutically-acceptable carriers include: (1) sugars,
such as lactose, glucose and sucrose; (2) starches, such as corn starch and potato
starch; (3) cellulose, and its derivatives, such as sodium carboxymethyl cellulose,
ethyl cellulose and cellulose acetate; (4) powdered tragacanth; (5) malt; (6) gelatin;
(7) talc; (8) excipients, such as cocoa butter and suppository waxes; (9) oils, such
as peanut oil, cottonseed oil, safflower oil, sesame oil, olive oil, corn oil and
soybean oil; (10) glycols, such as propylene glycol; (11) polyols, such as glycerin,
sorbitol, mannitol and polyethylene glycol; (12) esters, such as ethyl oleate and
ethyl laurate; (13) agar; (14) buffering agents, such as magnesium hydroxide and aluminum
hydroxide; (15) alginic acid; (16) pyrogen-free water; (17) isotonic saline; (18)
Ringer's solution; (19) ethyl alcohol; (20) pH buffered solutions; (21) polyesters,
polycarbonates and/or polyanhydrides; and (22) other non-toxic compatible substances
employed in pharmaceutical formulations.
[0123] As set out above, certain embodiments of the present compounds may contain a basic
functional group, such as amino or alkylamino, and are, thus, capable of forming pharmaceutically-acceptable
salts with pharmaceutically-acceptable acids. The term "pharmaceutically-acceptable
salts" in this respect, refers to the relatively non-toxic, inorganic and organic
acid addition salts of compounds of the present invention. These salts can be prepared
in situ in the administration vehicle or the dosage form manufacturing process, or by separately
reacting a purified compound of the invention in its free base form with a suitable
organic or inorganic acid, and isolating the salt thus formed during subsequent purification.
Representative salts include the hydrobromide, hydrochloride, sulfate, bisulfate,
phosphate, nitrate, acetate, valerate, oleate, palmitate, stearate, laurate, benzoate,
lactate, phosphate, tosylate, citrate, maleate, fumarate, succinate, tartrate, napthylate,
mesylate, glucoheptonate, lactobionate, and laurylsulphonate salts and the like. (See,
for example,
Berge et al. (1977) "Pharmaceutical Salts", J. Pharm. Sci. 66:1-19).
[0124] The pharmaceutically acceptable salts of the subject compounds include the conventional
nontoxic salts or quaternary ammonium salts of the compounds,
e.g., from non-toxic organic or inorganic acids. For example, such conventional nontoxic
salts include those derived from inorganic acids such as hydrochloride, hydrobromic,
sulfuric, sulfamic, phosphoric, nitric, and the like; and the salts prepared from
organic acids such as acetic, propionic, succinic, glycolic, stearic, lactic, malic,
tartaric, citric, ascorbic, palmitic, maleic, hydroxymaleic, phenylacetic, glutamic,
benzoic, salicyclic, sulfanilic, 2-acetoxybenzoic, fumaric, toluenesulfonic, methanesulfonic,
ethane disulfonic, oxalic, isothionic, and the like.
[0125] In other cases, the compounds of the present invention may contain one or more acidic
functional groups and, thus, are capable of forming pharmaceutically-acceptable salts
with pharmaceutically-acceptable bases. The term "pharmaceutically-acceptable salts"
in these instances refers to the relatively non-toxic, inorganic and organic base
addition salts of compounds of the present invention. These salts can likewise be
prepared
in situ in the administration vehicle or the dosage form manufacturing process, or by separately
reacting the purified compound in its free acid form with a suitable base, such as
the hydroxide, carbonate or bicarbonate of a pharmaceutically-acceptable metal cation,
with ammonia, or with a pharmaceutically-acceptable organic primary, secondary or
tertiary amine. Representative alkali or alkaline earth salts include the lithium,
sodium, potassium, calcium, magnesium, and aluminum salts and the like. Representative
organic amines useful for the formation of base addition salts include ethylamine,
diethylamine, ethylenediamine, ethanolamine, diethanolamine, piperazine and the like.
(See, for example, Berge et al.,
supra)
[0126] Wetting agents, emulsifiers and lubricants, such as sodium lauryl sulfate and magnesium
stearate, as well as coloring agents, release agents, coating agents, sweetening,
flavoring and perfuming agents, preservatives and antioxidants can also be present
in the compositions.
[0127] Examples of pharmaceutically-acceptable antioxidants include: (1) water soluble antioxidants,
such as ascorbic acid, cysteine hydrochloride, sodium bisulfate, sodium metabisulfite,
sodium sulfite and the like; (2) oil-soluble antioxidants, such as ascorbyl palmitate,
butylated hydroxyanisole (BHA), butylated hydroxytoluene (BHT), lecithin, propyl gallate,
alpha-tocopherol, and the like; and (3) metal chelating agents, such as citric acid,
ethylenediamine tetraacetic acid (EDTA), sorbitol, tartaric acid, phosphoric acid,
and the like.
[0128] Formulations of the present invention include those suitable for oral, nasal, topical
(including buccal and sublingual), rectal, vaginal and/or parenteral administration.
The formulations may conveniently be presented in unit dosage form and may be prepared
by any methods well known in the art of pharmacy. The amount of active ingredient
which can be combined with a carrier material to produce a single dosage form will
vary depending upon the host being treated, the particular mode of administration.
The amount of active ingredient which can be combined with a carrier material to produce
a single dosage form will generally be that amount of the compound which produces
a therapeutic effect. Generally, out of one hundred per cent, this amount will range
from about 0.1 per cent to about ninety-nine percent of active ingredient, preferably
from about 5 per cent to about 70 per cent, most preferably from about 10 percent
to about 30 percent.
[0129] In certain embodiments, a formulation of the present invention comprises an excipient
selected from the group consisting of cyclodextrins, celluloses, liposomes, micelle
forming agents,
e.g., bile acids, and polymeric carriers,
e.g., polyesters and polyanhydrides; and a compound of the present invention. In certain
embodiments, an aforementioned formulation renders orally bioavailable a compound
of the present invention.
[0130] Methods of preparing these formulations or compositions include the step of bringing
into association a compound of the present invention with the carrier and, optionally,
one or more accessory ingredients. In general, the formulations are prepared by uniformly
and intimately bringing into association a compound of the present invention with
liquid carriers, or finely divided solid carriers, or both, and then, if necessary,
shaping the product.
[0131] Formulations of the invention suitable for oral administration may be in the form
of capsules, cachets, pills, tablets, lozenges (using a flavored basis, usually sucrose
and acacia or tragacanth), powders, granules, or as a solution, suspension or solid
dispersion in an aqueous or non-aqueous liquid, or as an oil-in-water or water-in-oil
liquid emulsion, or as an elixir or syrup, or as pastilles (using an inert base, such
as gelatin and glycerin, or sucrose and acacia) and/or as mouth washes and the like,
each containing a predetermined amount of a compound of the present invention as an
active ingredient. A compound of the present invention may also be administered as
a bolus, electuary or paste.
[0132] A solid dispersion formulation comprises, for example, an amorphous dispersion of
a compound of the invention, an excipient (copolymers, such as the polyvinyl pyrrolidinone
(PVP) VA64 (Kollidon® VA64 or Copovidone), and the like). The solid dispersion can
further be enhanced with low viscosity hydroxyl propyl methyl celluloses (HPMCs) (such
as Pharmacoat 603, Methocel E3, or the like). See Example 41, below, for more specific
details for the preparation of a solid dispersion formulation of the invention.
[0133] A pharmaceutical composition may comprise an amorphous dispersion of (R)-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(Example 9) and 1 to 2 excipients; wherein the excipient is selected from HPMC AS,
Pharmacoat 603, Eudragit L100, PVP K30, PVP VA64 and Eudragit EPO.
[0134] In an embodiment, the excipients are PVP VA64 and Pharmacoat 603.
[0135] In a further embodiment, the percentage of Pharmacoat 603 is in the range of 30%
to 45%, the percentage of PVP VA64 is in the range of 30% to 45% and the percentage
of (R)-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(Example 9) is in the range of 20% to 30%.
[0136] In a further embodiment, the percentage of Pharmacoat 603 is 37.5%, the percentage
of PVP VA64 is 37.5% and the percentage of (R)-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(Example 9) is 25%.
[0137] In solid dosage forms of the invention for oral administration (capsules, tablets,
pills, dragees, powders, granules, trouches and the like), the active ingredient is
mixed with one or more pharmaceutically-acceptable carriers, such as sodium citrate
or dicalcium phosphate, and/or any of the following: (1) fillers or extenders, such
as starches, lactose, sucrose, glucose, mannitol, and/or silicic acid; (2) binders,
such as, for example, carboxymethylcellulose, alginates, gelatin, polyvinyl pyrrolidone,
sucrose and/or acacia; (3) humectants, such as glycerol; (4) disintegrating agents,
such as agar-agar, calcium carbonate, potato or tapioca starch, alginic acid, certain
silicates, and sodium carbonate; (5) solution retarding agents, such as paraffin;
(6) absorption accelerators, such as quaternary ammonium compounds and surfactants,
such as poloxamer and sodium lauryl sulfate; (7) wetting agents, such as, for example,
cetyl alcohol, glycerol monostearate, and non-ionic surfactants; (8) absorbents, such
as kaolin and bentonite clay; (9) lubricants, such as talc, calcium stearate, magnesium
stearate, solid polyethylene glycols, sodium lauryl sulfate, zinc stearate, sodium
stearate, stearic acid, and mixtures thereof; (10) coloring agents; and (11) controlled
release agents such as crospovidone or ethyl cellulose. In the case of capsules, tablets
and pills, the pharmaceutical compositions may also comprise buffering agents. Solid
compositions of a similar type may also be employed as fillers in soft and hard-shelled
gelatin capsules using such excipients as lactose or milk sugars, as well as high
molecular weight polyethylene glycols and the like.
[0138] A tablet may be made by compression or molding, optionally with one or more accessory
ingredients. Compressed tablets may be prepared using binder (for example, gelatin
or hydroxypropylmethyl cellulose), lubricant, inert diluent, preservative, disintegrant
(for example, sodium starch glycolate or cross-linked sodium carboxymethyl cellulose),
surface-active or dispersing agent. Molded tablets may be made by molding in a suitable
machine a mixture of the powdered compound moistened with an inert liquid diluent.
[0139] The tablets, and other solid dosage forms of the pharmaceutical compositions of the
present invention, such as dragees, capsules, pills and granules, may optionally be
scored or prepared with coatings and shells, such as enteric coatings and other coatings
well known in the pharmaceutical-formulating art. They may also be formulated so as
to provide slow or controlled release of the active ingredient therein using, for
example, hydroxypropylmethyl cellulose in varying proportions to provide the desired
release profile, other polymer matrices, liposomes and/or microspheres. They may be
formulated for rapid release,
e.g., freeze-dried. They may be sterilized by, for example, filtration through a bacteria-retaining
filter, or by incorporating sterilizing agents in the form of sterile solid compositions
which can be dissolved in sterile water, or some other sterile injectable medium immediately
before use. These compositions may also optionally contain opacifying agents and may
be of a composition that they release the active ingredient(s) only, or preferentially,
in a certain portion of the gastrointestinal tract, optionally, in a delayed manner.
Examples of embedding compositions which can be used include polymeric substances
and waxes. The active ingredient can also be in micro-encapsulated form, if appropriate,
with one or more of the above-described excipients.
[0140] Liquid dosage forms for oral administration of the compounds of the invention include
pharmaceutically acceptable emulsions, microemulsions, solutions, suspensions, syrups
and elixirs. In addition to the active ingredient, the liquid dosage forms may contain
inert diluents commonly used in the art, such as, for example, water or other solvents,
solubilizing agents and emulsifiers, such as ethyl alcohol, isopropyl alcohol, ethyl
carbonate, ethyl acetate, benzyl alcohol, benzyl benzoate, propylene glycol, 1,3-butylene
glycol, oils (in particular, cottonseed, groundnut, corn, germ, olive, castor and
sesame oils), glycerol, tetrahydrofuryl alcohol, polyethylene glycols and fatty acid
esters of sorbitan, and mixtures thereof.
[0141] Besides inert diluents, the oral compositions can also include adjuvants such as
wetting agents, emulsifying and suspending agents, sweetening, flavoring, coloring,
perfuming and preservative agents.
[0142] Suspensions, in addition to the active compounds, may contain suspending agents as,
for example, ethoxylated isostearyl alcohols, polyoxyethylene sorbitol and sorbitan
esters, microcrystalline cellulose, aluminum metahydroxide, bentonite, agar-agar and
tragacanth, and mixtures thereof.
[0143] Formulations of the pharmaceutical compositions of the invention for rectal or vaginal
administration may be presented as a suppository, which may be prepared by mixing
one or more compounds of the invention with one or more suitable nonirritating excipients
or carriers comprising, for example, cocoa butter, polyethylene glycol, a suppository
wax or a salicylate, and which is solid at room temperature, but liquid at body temperature
and, therefore, will melt in the rectum or vaginal cavity and release the active compound.
[0144] Formulations of the present invention which are suitable for vaginal administration
also include pessaries, tampons, creams, gels, pastes, foams or spray formulations
containing such carriers as are known in the art to be appropriate.
[0145] Dosage forms for the topical or transdermal administration of a compound of this
invention include powders, sprays, ointments, pastes, creams, lotions, gels, solutions,
patches and inhalants. The active compound may be mixed under sterile conditions with
a pharmaceutically-acceptable carrier, and with any preservatives, buffers, or propellants
which may be required.
[0146] The ointments, pastes, creams and gels may contain, in addition to an active compound
of this invention, excipients, such as animal and vegetable fats, oils, waxes, paraffins,
starch, tragacanth, cellulose derivatives, polyethylene glycols, silicones, bentonites,
silicic acid, talc and zinc oxide, or mixtures thereof.
[0147] Powders and sprays can contain, in addition to a compound of this invention, excipients
such as lactose, talc, silicic acid, aluminum hydroxide, calcium silicates and polyamide
powder, or mixtures of these substances. Sprays can additionally contain customary
propellants, such as chlorofluorohydrocarbons and volatile unsubstituted hydrocarbons,
such as butane and propane.
[0148] Transdermal patches have the added advantage of providing controlled delivery of
a compound of the present invention to the body. Such dosage forms can be made by
dissolving or dispersing the compound in the proper medium. Absorption enhancers can
also be used to increase the flux of the compound across the skin. The rate of such
flux can be controlled by either providing a rate controlling membrane or dispersing
the compound in a polymer matrix or gel.
[0149] Ophthalmic formulations, eye ointments, powders, solutions and the like, are also
contemplated as being within the scope of this invention.
[0150] Pharmaceutical compositions of this invention suitable for parenteral administration
comprise one or more compounds of the invention in combination with one or more pharmaceutically-acceptable
sterile isotonic aqueous or nonaqueous solutions, dispersions, suspensions or emulsions,
or sterile powders which may be reconstituted into sterile injectable solutions or
dispersions just prior to use, which may contain sugars, alcohols, antioxidants, buffers,
bacteriostats, solutes which render the formulation isotonic with the blood of the
intended recipient or suspending or thickening agents.
[0151] Examples of suitable aqueous and nonaqueous carriers which may be employed in the
pharmaceutical compositions of the invention include water, ethanol, polyols (such
as glycerol, propylene glycol, polyethylene glycol, and the like), and suitable mixtures
thereof, vegetable oils, such as olive oil, and injectable organic esters, such as
ethyl oleate. Proper fluidity can be maintained, for example, by the use of coating
materials, such as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required particle size in the
case of dispersions, and by the use of surfactants.
[0152] These compositions may also contain adjuvants such as preservatives, wetting agents,
emulsifying agents and dispersing agents. Prevention of the action of microorganisms
upon the subject compounds may be ensured by the inclusion of various antibacterial
and antifungal agents, for example, paraben, chlorobutanol, phenol sorbic acid, and
the like. It may also be desirable to include isotonic agents, such as sugars, sodium
chloride, and the like into the compositions. In addition, prolonged absorption of
the injectable pharmaceutical form may be brought about by the inclusion of agents
which delay absorption such as aluminum monostearate and gelatin.
[0153] In some cases, in order to prolong the effect of a drug, it is desirable to slow
the absorption of the drug from subcutaneous or intramuscular injection. This may
be accomplished by the use of a liquid suspension of crystalline or amorphous material
having poor water solubility. The rate of absorption of the drug then depends upon
its rate of dissolution which, in turn, may depend upon crystal size and crystalline
form. Alternatively, delayed absorption of a parenterally-administered drug form is
accomplished by dissolving or suspending the drug in an oil vehicle.
[0154] Injectable depot forms are made by forming microencapsule matrices of the subject
compounds in biodegradable polymers such as polylactide-polyglycolide. Depending on
the ratio of drug to polymer, and the nature of the particular polymer employed, the
rate of drug release can be controlled. Examples of other biodegradable polymers include
poly(orthoesters) and poly(anhydrides). Depot injectable formulations are also prepared
by entrapping the drug in liposomes or microemulsions which are compatible with body
tissue.
[0155] When the compounds of the present invention are administered as pharmaceuticals,
to humans and animals, they can be given per se or as a pharmaceutical composition
containing, for example, 0.1 to 99% (more preferably, 10 to 30%) of active ingredient
in combination with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
[0156] The preparations of the present invention may be given orally, parenterally, topically,
or rectally. They are of course given in forms suitable for each administration route.
For example, they are administered in tablets or capsule form, by injection, inhalation,
eye lotion, ointment, suppository,
etc. administration by injection, infusion or inhalation; topical by lotion or ointment;
and rectal by suppositories. Oral administrations are preferred.
[0157] The phrases "parenteral administration" and "administered parenterally" as used herein
means modes of administration other than enteral and topical administration, usually
by injection, and includes, without limitation, intravenous, intramuscular, intraarterial,
intrathecal, intracapsular, intraorbital, intracardiac, intradermal, intraperitoneal,
transtracheal, subcutaneous, subcuticular, intraarticulare, subcapsular, subarachnoid,
intraspinal and intrasternal injection and infusion.
[0158] The phrases "systemic administration," "administered systemically," "peripheral administration"
and "administered peripherally" as used herein mean the administration of a compound,
drug or other material other than directly into the central nervous system, such that
it enters the patient's system and, thus, is subject to metabolism and other like
processes, for example, subcutaneous administration.
[0159] These compounds may be administered to humans and other animals for therapy by any
suitable route of administration, including orally, nasally, as by, for example, a
spray, rectally, intravaginally, parenterally, intracisternally and topically, as
by powders, ointments or drops, including buccally and sublingually.
[0160] Regardless of the route of administration selected, the compounds of the present
invention, which may be used in a suitable hydrated form, and/or the pharmaceutical
compositions of the present invention, are formulated into pharmaceutically-acceptable
dosage forms by conventional methods known to those of skill in the art.
[0161] Actual dosage levels of the active ingredients in the pharmaceutical compositions
of this invention may be varied so as to obtain an amount of the active ingredient
which is effective to achieve the desired therapeutic response for a particular patient,
composition, and mode of administration, without being toxic to the patient.
[0162] The selected dosage level will depend upon a variety of factors including the activity
of the particular compound of the present invention employed, or the ester, salt or
amide thereof, the route of administration, the time of administration, the rate of
excretion or metabolism of the particular compound being employed, the rate and extent
of absorption, the duration of the treatment, other drugs, compounds and/or materials
used in combination with the particular compound employed, the age, sex, weight, condition,
general health and prior medical history of the patient being treated, and like factors
well known in the medical arts.
[0163] A physician or veterinarian having ordinary skill in the art can readily determine
and prescribe the effective amount of the pharmaceutical composition required. For
example, the physician or veterinarian could start doses of the compounds of the invention
employed in the pharmaceutical composition at levels lower than that required in order
to achieve the desired therapeutic effect and gradually increase the dosage until
the desired effect is achieved.
[0164] In general, a suitable daily dose of a compound of the invention will be that amount
of the compound which is the lowest dose effective to produce a therapeutic effect.
Such an effective dose will generally depend upon the factors described above. Generally,
oral, intravenous, intracerebroventricular and subcutaneous doses of the compounds
of this invention for a patient, when used for the indicated analgesic effects, will
range from about 0.0001 to about 100 mg per kilogram of body weight per day.
[0165] If desired, the effective daily dose of the active compound may be administered as
two, three, four, five, six or more sub-doses administered separately at appropriate
intervals throughout the day, optionally, in unit dosage forms.
[0166] In vivo PK parameters can be utilized for the estimation of human PK parameters. Applying
various methods known in the art for prediction of human PK, the predicted human clearance
can be estimated. For example, (R)-N-(4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(Example 9) was estimated to be 3 mL/min/kg and volume of distribution was estimated
to be 1 L/kg. The projected human efficacious daily dose for Example 9 was, therefore,
estimated to be between 90 and 130 mg/day.
[0167] While it is possible for a compound of the present invention to be administered alone,
it is preferable to administer the compound as a pharmaceutical formulation (composition).
[0168] The compounds according to the invention may be formulated for administration in
any convenient way for use in human or veterinary medicine, by analogy with other
pharmaceuticals.
[0169] In another aspect, the present invention provides pharmaceutically acceptable compositions
which comprise a therapeutically-effective amount of one or more of the subject compounds,
as described above, formulated together with one or more pharmaceutically acceptable
carriers (additives) and/or diluents. As described in detail below, the pharmaceutical
compositions of the present invention may be specially formulated for administration
in solid or liquid form, including those adapted for the following: (1) oral administration,
for example, drenches (aqueous or non-aqueous solutions or suspensions), tablets,
boluses, powders, granules, pastes for application to the tongue; (2) parenteral administration,
for example, by subcutaneous, intramuscular or intravenous injection as, for example,
a sterile solution or suspension; (3) topical application, for example, as a cream,
ointment or spray applied to the skin, lungs, or mucous membranes; or (4) intravaginally
or intrarectally, for example, as a pessary, cream or foam; (5) sublingually or buccally;
(6) ocularly; (7) transdermally; or (8) nasally.
[0170] The term "treatment" is intended to encompass also prophylaxis, therapy and cure.
[0171] The patient receiving this treatment is any animal in need, including primates, in
particular humans, and other mammals such as equines, cattle, swine and sheep; and
poultry and pets in general.
[0172] Microemulsification technology can improve bioavailability of some lipophilic (water
insoluble) pharmaceutical agents. Examples include Trimetrine (
Dordunoo, S. K., et al., Drug Development and Industrial Pharmacy, 17(12), 1685-1713,
1991 and REV 5901 (
Sheen, P. C., et al., J Pharm Sci 80(7), 712-714, 1991). Among other things, microemulsification provides enhanced bioavailability by preferentially
directing absorption to the lymphatic system instead of the circulatory system, which
thereby bypasses the liver, and prevents destruction of the compounds in the hepatobiliary
circulation.
[0173] While all suitable amphiphilic carriers are contemplated, the presently preferred
carriers are generally those that have Generally-Recognized-as-Safe (GRAS) status,
and that can both solubilize the compound of the present invention and microemulsify
it at a later stage when the solution comes into a contact with a complex water phase
(such as one found in human gastrointestinal tract). Usually, amphiphilic ingredients
that satisfy these requirements have HLB (hydrophilic to lipophilic balance) values
of 2-20, and their structures contain straight chain aliphatic radicals in the range
of C-6 to C-20. Examples are polyethylene-glycolized fatty glycerides and polyethylene
glycols.
[0174] Commercially available amphiphilic carriers are particularly contemplated, including
Gelucire-series, Labrafil, Labrasol, or Lauroglycol (all manufactured and distributed
by Gattefosse Corporation, Saint Priest, France), PEG-mono-oleate, PEG-di-oleate,
PEG-monolaurate and di-laurate, Lecithin, Polysorbate 80, etc (produced and distributed
by a number of companies in USA and worldwide).
[0175] Hydrophilic polymers suitable for use in the present invention are those which are
readily water-soluble, can be covalently attached to a vesicle-forming lipid, and
which are tolerated in vivo without toxic effects (
i.e., are biocompatible). Suitable polymers include polyethylene glycol (PEG), polylactic
(also termed polylactide), polyglycolic acid (also termed polyglycolide), a polylactic-polyglycolic
acid copolymer, and polyvinyl alcohol. Preferred polymers are those having a molecular
weight of from about 100 or 120 daltons up to about 5,000 or 10,000 daltons, and more
preferably from about 300 daltons to about 5,000 daltons. In a particularly preferred
embodiment, the polymer is polyethyleneglycol having a molecular weight of from about
100 to about 5,000 daltons, and more preferably having a molecular weight of from
about 300 to about 5,000 daltons. In a particularly preferred embodiment, the polymer
is polyethyleneglycol of 750 daltons (PEG(750)). Polymers may also be defined by the
number of monomers therein; a preferred embodiment of the present invention utilizes
polymers of at least about three monomers, such PEG polymers consisting of three monomers
(approximately 150 daltons).
[0176] Other hydrophilic polymers which may be suitable for use in the present invention
include polyvinylpyrrolidone, polymethoxazoline, polyethyloxazoline, polyhydroxypropyl
methacrylamide, polymethacrylamide, polydimethylacrylamide, and derivatized celluloses
such as hydroxymethylcellulose or hydroxyethylcellulose.
[0177] A formulation may comprise a biocompatible polymer selected from the group consisting
of polyamides, polycarbonates, polyalkylenes, polymers of acrylic and methacrylic
esters, polyvinyl polymers, polyglycolides, polysiloxanes, polyurethanes and co-polymers
thereof, celluloses, polypropylene, polyethylenes, polystyrene, polymers of lactic
acid and glycolic acid, polyanhydrides, poly(ortho)esters, poly(butic acid), poly(valeric
acid), poly(lactide-co-caprolactone), polysaccharides, proteins, polyhyaluronic acids,
polycyanoacrylates, and blends, mixtures, or copolymers thereof.
[0178] Cyclodextrins are cyclic oligosaccharides, consisting of 6, 7 or 8 glucose units,
designated by the Greek letter alpha, beta or gamma, respectively. Cyclodextrins with
fewer than six glucose units are not known to exist. The glucose units are linked
by alpha-1,4-glucosidic bonds. As a consequence of the chair conformation of the sugar
units, all secondary hydroxyl groups (at C-2, C-3) are located on one side of the
ring, while all the primary hydroxyl groups at C-6 are situated on the other side.
As a result, the external faces are hydrophilic, making the cyclodextrins water-soluble.
In contrast, the cavities of the cyclodextrins are hydrophobic, since they are lined
by the hydrogen of atoms C-3 and C-5, and by ether-like oxygens. These matrices allow
complexation with a variety of relatively hydrophobic compounds, including, for instance,
steroid compounds such as 17-beta-estradiol (see,
e.g., van Uden et al. Plant Cell Tiss. Org. Cult. 38:1-3-113 (1994)). The complexation takes place by Van der Waals interactions and by hydrogen bond
formation. For a general review of the chemistry of cyclodextrins, see,
Wenz, Agnew. Chem. Int. Ed. Engl., 33:803-822 (1994).
[0179] The physico-chemical properties of the cyclodextrin derivatives depend strongly on
the kind and the degree of substitution. For example, their solubility in water ranges
from insoluble (
e.g., triacetyl-beta-cyclodextrin) to 147% soluble (w/v) (G-2-beta-cyclodextrin). In
addition, they are soluble in many organic solvents. The properties of the cyclodextrins
enable the control over solubility of various formulation components by increasing
or decreasing their solubility.
[0180] Numerous cyclodextrins and methods for their preparation have been described. For
example,
Parmeter (I), et al. (U.S. Pat. No. 3,453,259) and
Gramera, et al. (U.S. Pat. No. 3,459,731) described electroneutral cyclodextrins. Other derivatives include cyclodextrins
with cationic properties [
Parmeter (II), U.S. Pat. No. 3,453,257], insoluble crosslinked cyclodextrins (
Solms, U.S. Pat. No. 3,420,788), and cyclodextrins with anionic properties [
Parmeter (III), U.S. Pat. No. 3,426,011]. Among the cyclodextrin derivatives with anionic properties, carboxylic acids, phosphorous
acids, phosphinous acids, phosphonic acids, phosphoric acids, thiophosphonic acids,
thiosulphinic acids, and sulfonic acids have been appended to the parent cyclodextrin
[see, Parmeter (III), supra]. Furthermore, sulfoalkyl ether cyclodextrin derivatives
have been described by
Stella, et al. (U.S. Pat. No. 5,134,127).
[0181] Liposomes consist of at least one lipid bilayer membrane enclosing an aqueous internal
compartment. Liposomes may be characterized by membrane type and by size. Small unilamellar
vesicles (SUVs) have a single membrane and typically range between 0.02 and 0.05 µm
in diameter; large unilamellar vesicles (LUVS) are typically larger than 0.05 µm Oligolamellar
large vesicles and multilamellar vesicles have multiple, usually concentric, membrane
layers and are typically larger than 0.1 µm. Liposomes with several nonconcentric
membranes, i.e., several smaller vesicles contained within a larger vesicle, are termed
multivesicular vesicles.
[0182] One disclosure relates to formulations comprising liposomes containing a compound
of the present invention, where the liposome membrane is formulated to provide a liposome
with increased carrying capacity. Alternatively or in addition, the compound of the
present invention may be contained within, or adsorbed onto, the liposome bilayer
of the liposome. The compound of the present invention may be aggregated with a lipid
surfactant and carried within the liposome's internal space; in these cases, the liposome
membrane is formulated to resist the disruptive effects of the active agent-surfactant
aggregate.
[0183] The lipid bilayer of a liposome contains lipids derivatized with polyethylene glycol
(PEG), such that the PEG chains extend from the inner surface of the lipid bilayer
into the interior space encapsulated by the liposome, and extend from the exterior
of the lipid bilayer into the surrounding environment.
[0184] Active agents contained within liposomes are in solubilized form. Aggregates of surfactant
and active agent (such as emulsions or micelles containing the active agent of interest)
may be entrapped within the interior space of liposomes. A surfactant acts to disperse
and solubilize the active agent, and may be selected from any suitable aliphatic,
cycloaliphatic or aromatic surfactant, including but not limited to biocompatible
lysophosphatidylcholines (LPCs) of varying chain lengths (for example, from about
C.sub. 14 to about C.sub.20). Polymer-derivatized lipids such as PEG-lipids may also
be utilized for micelle formation as they will act to inhibit micelle/membrane fusion,
and as the addition of a polymer to surfactant molecules decreases the CMC of the
surfactant and aids in micelle formation. Preferred are surfactants with CMCs in the
micromolar range; higher CMC surfactants may be utilized to prepare micelles entrapped
within liposomes, however, micelle surfactant monomers could affect liposome bilayer
stability and would be a factor in designing a liposome of a desired stability.
[0185] Liposomes may be prepared by any of a variety of techniques that are known in the
art. See,
e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,235,871; Published
PCT applications WO 96/14057;
New RRC, Liposomes: A practical approach, IRL Press, Oxford (1990), pages 33-104;
Lasic DD, Liposomes from physics to applications, Elsevier Science Publishers BV,
Amsterdam, 1993.
[0186] For example, liposomes may be prepared by diffusing a lipid derivatized with a hydrophilic
polymer into preformed liposomes, such as by exposing preformed liposomes to micelles
composed of lipid-grafted polymers, at lipid concentrations corresponding to the final
mole percent of derivatized lipid which is desired in the liposome. Liposomes containing
a hydrophilic polymer can also be formed by homogenization, lipid-field hydration,
or extrusion techniques, as are known in the art.
[0187] In onedisclosure, the liposomes are prepared to have substantially homogeneous sizes
in a selected size range. One effective sizing method involves extruding an aqueous
suspension of the liposomes through a series of polycarbonate membranes having a selected
uniform pore size; the pore size of the membrane will correspond roughly with the
largest sizes of liposomes produced by extrusion through that membrane. See
e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,737,323 (Apr. 12, 1988).
[0188] The release characteristics of a formulation depend on the encapsulating material,
the concentration of encapsulated drug, and the presence of release modifiers. For
example, release can be manipulated to be pH dependent, for example, using a pH sensitive
coating that releases only at a low pH, as in the stomach, or a higher pH, as in the
intestine. An enteric coating can be used to prevent release from occurring until
after passage through the stomach. Multiple coatings or mixtures of cyanamide encapsulated
in different materials can be used to obtain an initial release in the stomach, followed
by later release in the intestine. Release can also be manipulated by inclusion of
salts or pore forming agents, which can increase water uptake or release of drug by
diffusion from the capsule. Excipients which modify the solubility of the drug can
also be used to control the release rate. Agents which enhance degradation of the
matrix or release from the matrix can also be incorporated. They can be added to the
drug, added as a separate phase (
i.e., as particulates), or can be co-dissolved in the polymer phase depending on the compound.
In all cases the amount should be between 0.1 and thirty percent (w/w polymer). Types
of degradation enhancers include inorganic salts such as ammonium sulfate and ammonium
chloride, organic acids such as citric acid, benzoic acid, and ascorbic acid, inorganic
bases such as sodium carbonate, potassium carbonate, calcium carbonate, zinc carbonate,
and zinc hydroxide, and organic bases such as protamine sulfate, spermine, choline,
ethanolamine, diethanolamine, and triethanolamine and surfactants such as Tween® and
Pluronic®. Pore forming agents which add microstructure to the matrices (
i.e., water soluble compounds such as inorganic salts and sugars) are added as particulates.
The range should be between one and thirty percent (w/w polymer).
[0189] Uptake can also be manipulated by altering residence time of the particles in the
gut. This can be achieved, for example, by coating the particle with, or selecting
as the encapsulating material, a mucosal adhesive polymer. Examples include most polymers
with free carboxyl groups, such as chitosan, celluloses, and especially polyacrylates
(as used herein, polyacrylates refers to polymers including acrylate groups and modified
acrylate groups such as cyanoacrylates and methacrylates).
Pharmaceutical Combinations
[0190] The invention especially relates to a compound of the formula (I) (or a pharmaceutical
composition comprising a compound of the formula (I)) for use in the treatment of
one or more of the diseases mentioned herein; wherein the response to treatment is
beneficial as demonstrated, for example, by the partial or complete removal of one
or more of the symptoms of the disease up to complete cure or remission.
[0191] Philadelphia chromosome positive (Ph+) ALL accounts for 15-30 % of adult ALL and
up to 5% of pediatric ALL (
Faderl S, Garcia-MAnero G, Thomas D, et al. Philadelphia Chromosome Positive Acute
Lymphoblastic Leukemia- Current Concepts and Future Perspectives. Rev Clin Exp Hematol
2002;6:142-160). Pediatric Ph+ ALL is characterized by an older age (median 9-10 years versus approximately
4 years for all ALL patients) and higher WBC counts at diagnosis. In both adults and
children, Ph+ ALL is characterized by a reciprocal translocation between chromosomes
9 and 22 (t(9;22)(q34;ql 1)) resulting in fusion of the
BCR gene on chromosome 22 with
ABL gene sequences translocated from chromosome 9, resulting in expression of the BCR-ABL1
protein. There are 2 primary variants of BCR-ABL1, p190BCR-ABL1, detectable in approximately
85% of Ph+ ALL patients, and p210 BCR-ABL1, typical of CML, identified in approximately
15% of Ph+ ALL patients (
Dombret H, Galbert J, Boiron J, et al. Outcome of Treatment in Adults with Philadelphia
chromosome-posititve acute lymphoblastic leukemia- Results of the prospective multicenter
LALA-94 trial. Blood 2002; 100:2357-2366;
Faderl S, Garcia-MAnero G, Thomas D, et al. Philadelphia Chromosome Positive Acute
Lymphoblastic Leukemia- Current Concepts and Future Perspectives. Rev Clin Exp Hematol
2002;6:142-160).
[0192] The treatment of ALL is based on each patient's risk classification, with increasingly
intensive treatment for patients who are at higher risk of relapse; this strategy
maximizes remission rates while limiting unnecessary toxicities. Progress has been
incremental, from the introduction of combination chemotherapy and treatment for pre-symptomatic
central nervous system leukemia to newer, intensive treatment regimens for patients
at high risk for relapse (
C. H. Pui and W. E. Evans. Acute Lymphoblastic Leukemia New Engl J Med 1998;339:605-615;). Prior to the development of imatinib, Ph+ALL patients were treated with intensive
chemotherapy followed by hematopoietic stem cell transplant (HSCT), ideally with a
matched related donor, as this was shown to result in improved EFS versus either HSCT
with other donors or chemotherapy alone. Overall, and in contrast to the majority
of pediatric patients with ALL, patients with Ph+ALL have had a dire prognosis with
low rates of event free survival (EFS) (
Arico M, Valsecchi M G, Camitta B, Schrappe M, Chessells J, Baruchel A, Gaynon P,
Silverman L, Janka-Schaub G, Kamps W, et al. New Engl J Med 2000;342:998-1006).
[0193] Existing therapies (such as GLEEVEC®, TASIGNA®, SPRYCEL®, BOSULIF®, ICLUSIG™ and
the like) bind to the ATP binding site of the kinase domain. In contrast, compounds
of the invention are potent BCR-ABL1, ABL1 and ABL2 inhibitors that bind to a site
on the kinase domain that is distinct from the ATP-binding site.
[0194] Therefore, compounds of the invention with their novel, allosteric mechanism of action,
can be used as a stand-alone therapy or can be used sequentially or in combination
with existing therapies selected from GLEEVEC®, TASIGNA®, SPRYCEL®, BOSULIF® and ICLUSIG™.
[0195] As a stand-alone therapy, compounds of the invention can be used to treat BCR-ABL1,
ABL1 and ABL2 related diseases and disorders. BCR-ABL1 can be wild-type or a mutant
BCR-ABL1 selected from V299L, T315I, F317I/L, Y253F/H, E255K/V, and F359C/V. Compounds
of the invention could be used to treat patients who do not respond to existing therapies
as a result of mutations arising in the ATP-binding site. As a combination therapy,
compounds of the invention present a unique opportunity to treat patients with Ph+
leukemia using a combination of two potent, mechanistically distinct BCR-ABL inhibitors.
The combination approach in the clinic could provide patients with a deeper and more
sustained reduction in tumor burden with a reduced risk of relapse.
[0196] A warm-blooded animal having a leukemia selected from chronic myeloid leukemia (CML)
and acute lymphoblastic leukemia (ALL) may be treated comprising administering to
said animal a sequential administration of a therapeutically effective amount of a
compound of the invention or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof and therapeutically
effective amount of a compound selected from imatinib, nilotinib, dasatinib, bosutinib,
ponatinib and bafetinib.
[0197] The warm blooded animal may be human (patient).
[0198] The compound of the invention may be (R)-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(Example 9) or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
[0199] The dose of (R)-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(Example 9) may be 90-130 mg.
[0200] The dose of nilotinib may be 10-50 mg/kg, Imatinib may be 50-200mg/kg, dasatinib
may be 5-20 mg/kg or ponatinib may be 2-10 mg/kg.
[0201] The dose of bosutinib may be 500 mg.
[0202] A warm-blooded animal having a leukemia selected from chronic myeloid leukemia (CML)
and acute lymphoblastic leukemia (ALL) may be treated comprising administering to
said animal a simultaneous administration of a therapeutically effective amount of
a compound of the invention or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof and therapeutically
effective amount of a compound selected from imatinib, nilotinib, dasatinib, bosutinib,
ponatinib and bafetinib.
[0203] The warm blooded animal may be a human (patient).
[0204] The compound of the invention may be (R)-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(
Example 9) or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
[0205] The dose of (R)-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(Example 9) may be 90-130 mg.
[0206] The dose of nilotinib may be 10-50 mg/kg, Imatinib may be 50-200mg/kg, dasatinib
may be 5-20 mg/kg or ponatinib may be 2-10 mg/kg.
[0207] The dose of bosutinib may be 500 mg.
[0208] A warm-blooded animal having a leukemia selected from chronic myeloid leukemia (CML)
and acute lymphoblastic leukemia (ALL) may be treated comprising administering to
said animal a simultaneous administration of a therapeutically effective amount of
a (R)-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(
Example 9) or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof and therapeutically effective amount
of Nilotinib.
[0209] A compound of formula (I) can also be used in combination with other antineoplastic
compounds. Such compounds include, but are not limited to ribonucleotide reductase
inhibitors, topoisomerase I inhibitors; JAK inhibitors, such as ruxolitinib; smoothened
inhibitors, such as LDE225; interferon; topoisomerase II inhibitors; microtubule active
compounds; alkylating compounds; histone deacetylase inhibitors; mTOR inhibitors,such
as RAD001; antineoplastic antimetabolites; platin compounds; compounds targeting/decreasing
a protein or lipid kinase activity methionine aminopeptidase inhibitors; biological
response modifiers; inhibitors of Ras oncogenic isoforms; telomerase inhibitors; proteasome
inhibitors; compounds used in the treatment of hematologic malignancies, such as FLUDARABINE;
compounds which target, decrease or inhibit the activity of PKC, such as midostaurin;
HSP90 inhibitors such as 17-AAG (17-allylaminogeldanamycin, NSC330507), 17-DMAG (17-dimethylaminoethylamino-17-demethoxy-geldanamycin,
NSC707545), IPI-504, CNF1010, CNF2024, CNF1010 from Conforma Therapeutics, HSP990
and AUY922; temozolomide (TEMODAL®); kinesin spindle protein inhibitors, such as SB715992
or SB743921 from GlaxoSmithKline, or pentamidine/chlorpromazine from CombinatoRx;
PI3K inhibitors, such as BEZ235, BKM120 or BYL719; MEK inhibitors such as ARRY142886
from Array PioPharma, AZD6244 from AstraZeneca, PD181461 from Pfizer, leucovorin,
EDG binders, antileukemia compounds, S-adenosylmethionine decarboxylase inhibitors,
antiproliferative antibodies or other chemotherapeutic compounds. Further, alternatively
or in addition they may be used in combination with ionizing radiation. Further, alternatively
or in addition they may be used in combination with JAK inhibitors, such as ruxolitinib.
[0210] Further, alternatively or in addition they may be used in combination with smoothened
inhibitors, such as LDE225.
[0211] Further, alternatively or in addition they may be used in combination with interferon.
[0212] The term "ribonucleotide reductase inhibitors" refers to pyrimidine or purine nucleoside
analogues including, but not limited to, fludarabine and/or cytosine arabinoside (ara-C),
6-thioguanine, 5-fluorouracil, cladribine, 6-mercaptopurine (especially in combination
with ara-C against ALL), clofarabine, nelarabine (a prodrug of 9-β-arabinofuranosylguanine,
ara-G), pentostatin, hydroxyurea or 2-hydroxy-1
H-isoindole-1,3-dione derivatives (
Nandy et al., Acta Oncologica 1994;33:953-961.
[0213] The term "topoisomerase I inhibitor" as used herein includes, but is not limited
to topotecan, gimatecan, irinotecan, camptothecian and its analogues, 9-nitrocamptothecin
and the macromolecular camptothecin conjugate PNU-166148 (compound Al in
WO99/ 17804). Irinotecan can be administered,
e.g. in the form as it is marketed,
e.g. under the trademark CAMPTOSAR. Topotecan can be administered,
e.g., in the form as it is marketed,
e.g. under the trademark HYCAMTIN.
[0214] The term "topoisomerase II inhibitor" as used herein includes, but is not limited
to the anthracyclines such as doxorubicin (including liposomal formulation,
e.g. CAELYX), daunorubicin, epirubicin, idarubicin and nemorubicin, the anthraquinones
mitoxantrone and lo-soxantrone, and the podophillotoxines etoposide and teniposide.
Etoposide can be administered,
e.g. in the form as it is marketed,
e.g. under the trademark ETOPOPHOS. Teniposide can be administered,
e.g. in the form as it is marketed,
e.g. under the trademark VM 26-BRISTOL. Doxorubicin can be administered,
e.g. in the form as it is marketed,
e.g. under the trademark ADRIBLASTIN or ADRIAMYCIN. Epirubicin can be administered, in
the form as it is marketed. under the trademark FARMORUBICIN. Idarubicin can be administered,
e.g. in the form as it is marketed,
e.g. under the trademark ZAVEDOS. Mitoxantrone can be administered,
e.g. in the form as it is marketed,
e.g. under the trademark NOVANTRON.
[0215] The term "microtubule active compound" relates to microtubule stabilizing, microtubule
destabilizing compounds and microtublin polymerization inhibitors including, but not
limited to taxanes,
e.g. paclitaxel and docetaxel, vinca alkaloids,
e.g., vinblastine, especially vinblastine sulfate, vincristine especially vincristine sulfate,
and vinorelbine, discodermolides, cochicine and epothilones and derivatives thereof,
e.g. epothilone B or D or derivatives thereof. Paclitaxel may be administered
e.g. in the form as it is marketed,
e.g. TAXOL. Docetaxel can be administered,
e.g., in the form as it is marketed,
e.g. under the trademark TAXOTERE. Vinblastine sulfate can be administered,
e.g., in the form as it is marketed,
e.g. under the trademark VINBLASTIN R.P.. Vincristine sulfate can be administered,
e.g., in the form as it is marketed,
e.g. under the trademark FARMISTIN. Discodermolide can be obtained,
e.g., as disclosed in
US 5,010,099. Also included are Epothilone derivatives which are disclosed in
WO 98/10121,
US 6,194,181,
WO 98/25929,
WO 98/08849,
WO 99/43653,
WO 98/22461 and
WO 00/31247. Especially preferred are Epothilone A and/or B.
[0216] The term "alkylating compound" as used herein includes, but is not limited to, cyclophosphamide,
ifosfamide, melphalan or nitrosourea (BCNU or Gliadel). Cyclophosphamide can be administered,
e.g., in the form as it is marketed,
e.g. under the trademark CYCLOSTIN. Ifosfamide can be administered,
e.g., in the form as it is marketed,
e.g. under the trademark HOLOXAN.
[0217] The term "histone deacetylase inhibitors" or "HDAC inhibitors" relates to compounds
which inhibit the histone deacetylase and which possess antiproliferative activity.
This includes compounds such as LDH589 disclosed in
WO 02/22577, especially N-hydroxy-3-[4-[[(2-hydroxyethyl)[2-(1H-indol-3-yl)ethyl]-amino]methyl]phenyl]-2E-2-propenamide,
N-hydroxy-3-[4-[[[2-(2-methyl-1
H-indol-3-yl)-ethyl]-amino]methyl]phenyl]-2
E-2-propenamide and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof. It further especially
includes Suberoylanilide hydroxamic acid (SAHA).
[0218] The term "antineoplastic antimetabolite" includes, but is not limited to, 5-fluorouracil
or 5-FU, capecitabine, gemcitabine, DNA demethylating compounds, such as 5-azacytidine
and decitabine, methotrexate and edatrexate, and folic acid antagonists such as pemetrexed.
Capecitabine can be administered,
e.g., in the form as it is marketed,
e.g. under the trademark XELODA. Gemcitabine can be administered,
e.g., in the form as it is marketed,
e.g. under the trademark GEMZAR.
[0219] The term "platin compound" as used herein includes, but is not limited to, carboplatin,
cis-platin, cisplatinum and oxaliplatin. Carboplatin can be administered,
e.g., in the form as it is marketed,
e.g. under the trademark CARBOPLAT. Oxaliplatin can be administered,
e.g., in the form as it is marketed,
e.g. under the trademark ELOXATIN.
[0220] The term "compounds targeting/decreasing a protein or lipid kinase activity"; or
a "protein or lipid phosphatase activity" as used herein includes, but is not limited
to, protein tyrosine kinase and/or serine and/or threonine kinase inhibitors or lipid
kinase inhibitors, for example:
- a) compounds targeting, decreasing or inhibiting the activity of members of the ABL1
family, their gene-fusion products (e.g. BCR-ABL1 kinase) and mutants, such as compounds which target decrease or inhibit
the activity of ABL1 family members and their gene fusion products, e.g. imatinib, nilotinib, dasatinib, bosutinib, ponatinib, bafetinib, PD180970, AG957,
NSC 680410 and PD173955;
- b) compounds targeting, decreasing or inhibiting the activity of members of the protein
kinase C (PKC) and Raf family of serine/threonine kinases, members of the MEK, SRC,
JAK, FAK, PDK1, PKB/Akt, and Ras/MAPK family members, and/or members of the cyclin-dependent
kinase family (CDK) and are especially those staurosporine derivatives disclosed in
US 5,093,330, e.g. midostaurin; examples of further compounds include e.g. UCN-01, safingol, BAY 43-9006, Bryostatin 1, Perifosine; Ilmofosine; RO 318220 and
RO 320432; GO 6976; Isis 3521; LY333531/LY379196; isochinoline compounds such as those
disclosed in WO 00/09495; FTIs; BEZ235 (a P13K inhibitor) or AT7519 (CDK inhibitor);
[0221] The term "mTOR inhibitors" relates to compounds which inhibit the mammalian target
of rapamycin (mTOR) and which possess antiproliferative activity such as sirolimus
(Rapamune®), everolimus (Certican™), CCI-779 and ABT578.
[0222] The term " biological response modifier" as used herein refers to a lymphokine or
interferons,
e.g. interferon γ.
[0223] The term "inhibitor of Ras oncogenic isoforms",
e.g. H-Ras, K-Ras, or N-Ras, as used herein refers to compounds which target, decrease
or inhibit the oncogenic activity of Ras
e.g. a "farnesyl transferase inhibitor"
e.g. L-744832, DK8G557 or R115777 (Zarnestra).
[0224] The term "telomerase inhibitor" as used herein refers to compounds which target,
decrease or inhibit the activity of telomerase. Compounds which target, decrease or
inhibit the activity of telomerase are especially compounds which inhibit the telomerase
receptor,
e.g. telomestatin.
[0225] The term "methionine aminopeptidase inhibitor" as used herein refers to compounds
which target, decrease or inhibit the activity of methionine aminopeptidase. Compounds
which target, decrease or inhibit the activity of methionine aminopeptidase are
e.g. bengamide or a derivative thereof.
[0226] The term "proteasome inhibitor" as used herein refers to compounds which target,
decrease or inhibit the activity of the proteasome. Compounds which target, decrease
or inhibit the activity of the proteasome include
e.g. Bortezomid (Velcade™)and MLN 341.
[0227] The term "HSP90 inhibitors" as used herein includes, but is not limited to, compounds
targeting, decreasing or inhibiting the intrinsic ATPase activity of HSP90; degrading,
targeting, decreasing or inhibiting the HSP90 client proteins via the ubiquitin proteosome
pathway. Compounds targeting, decreasing or inhibiting the intrinsic ATPase activity
of HSP90 are especially compounds, proteins or antibodies which inhibit the ATPase
activity of HSP90
e.g., 17-allylamino,17-demethoxygeldanamycin (17AAG), a geldanamycin derivative; other
geldanamycin related compounds; radicicol and HDAC inhibitors. Example HSP90 inhibitors
are HSP990 and AUY922.
[0228] For the treatment of acute myeloid leukemia (AML), compounds of formula (I) can be
used in combination with standard leukemia therapies, especially in combination with
therapies used for the treatment of AML. In particular, compounds of formula (I) can
be administered in combination with,
e.g., farnesyl transferase inhibitors and/or other drugs useful for the treatment of AML,
such as Daunorubicin, Adriamycin, Ara-C, VP-16, Teniposide, Mitoxantrone, Idarubicin,
Carboplatinum and PKC412.
[0229] Compounds which target, decrease or inhibit activity of histone deacetylase (HDAC)
inhibitors such as sodium butyrate and suberoylanilide hydroxamic acid (SAHA) inhibit
the activity of the enzymes known as histone deacetylases. Specific HDAC inhibitors
include MS275, SAHA, FK228 (formerly FR901228), Trichostatin A and compounds disclosed
in
US 6,552,065, in particular,
N-hydroxy-3-[4-[[[2-(2-methyl-1
H-indol-3-yl)-ethyl]-amino]-methyl]phenyl]-2
E-2-propenamide, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof and
N-hydroxy-3-[4-[(2-hydroxyethyl) {2-(1
H-indol-3-yl)ethyl]-amino]methyl]phenyl]-2
E-2-propenamide, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, especially the lactate
salt.
[0230] Tumor cell damaging approaches refer to approaches such as ionizing radiation. The
term "ionizing radiation" referred to above and hereinafter means ionizing radiation
that occurs as either electromagnetic rays (such as X-rays and gamma rays) or particles
(such as alpha and beta particles). Ionizing radiation is provided in, but not limited
to, radiation therapy and is known in the art. See
Hellman, Principles of Radiation Therapy, Cancer, in Principles and Practice of Oncology,
Devita et al., Eds., 4th Edition, Vol. 1, pp. 248-275 (1993).
[0231] The term "S-adenosylmethionine decarboxylase inhibitors" as used herein includes,
but is not limited to the compounds disclosed in
US 5,461,076.
[0232] "Other chemotherapeutic compounds" include, but are not limited to, plant alkaloids,
hormonal compounds and antagonists; biological response modifiers, preferably lymphokines
or interferons; antisense oligonucleotides or oligonucleotide derivatives; shRNA or
siRNA; or miscellaneous compounds or compounds with other or unknown mechanism of
action.
[0233] The structure of the active compounds identified by code nos., generic or trade names
may be taken from the actual edition of the standard compendium "The Merck Index"
or from databases,
e.g. Patents International (
e.g. IMS World Publications).
[0234] None of the quotations of references made within the present disclosure is to be
understood as an admission that the references cited are prior art that would negatively
affect the patentability of the present invention.
Processes for Making Compounds of the Invention
[0235] The present disclosure also includes processes for the preparation of compounds of
the invention. In the reactions described, it can be necessary to protect reactive
functional groups, for example hydroxy, amino, imino, thio or carboxy groups, where
these are desired in the final product, to avoid their unwanted participation in the
reactions. Conventional protecting groups can be used in accordance with standard
practice, for example, see
T.W. Greene and P. G. M. Wuts in "Protective Groups in Organic Chemistry", John Wiley
and Sons, 1991.
[0236] Where temperatures are given hereinbefore or hereinafter, "about" has to be added,
as minor deviations from the numeric values given,
e.g. variations of ± 10 %, are tolerable. All reactions may take place in the presence
of one or more diluents and/or solvents. The starting materials may be used in equimolar
amounts; alternatively, a compound may be used in excess,
e.g. to function as a solvent or to shift equilibrium or to generally accelerate reaction
rates. Reaction aids, such as acids, bases or catalysts may be added in suitable amounts,
as known in the field, required by a reaction and in line with generally known procedures.
[0237] Compounds of formula (I) can be prepared by proceeding as in the following Reaction
Scheme I:

in which Y, Y
1, R
1, R
2, R
3 and R
4 are as defined for formula (I) in the Summary of the Invention and X
1 and X
2 represent halogen atoms, X
1 can be selected from chloro, bromo, or iodo and X
2 can be selected from chloro or fluoro.
[0238] Step a: A compound of formula (4) can be prepared by reacting the acid chloride from
a compound of formula (2) with a compound of formula (3) in the presence of a suitable
solvent (for example tetrahydrofuran, or the like), and an organic base (for example
diisopropylethylamine, or the like). The reaction takes place from about 0°C to about
room temperature and can take up to about 2 hours to complete.
[0239] The acid chloride of a compound of formula (2) can be prepared with a chlorinating
agent (for example thionyl chloride, or oxalyl chloride, or the like) in the presence
of a catalyst (for example dimethylformamide, or the like) and a suitable solvent
(for example toluene, or the like). The reaction takes place at about room temperature
or by heating to about 85°C and can take up to about 2 hours to complete.
[0240] Step b: A compound of formula (5) can be prepared by reacting a compound of formula
(4) with R
2-H wherein R
2 is as defined in the Summary of the Invention, in the presence of a suitable solvent
(for example 2-propanol, or dimethyl sulfoxide, or the like), and a suitable organic
base (for example diisopropylethylamine, or triethylamine, or the like). The reaction
takes place at about 90°C to about 140°C and can take from about 30 minutes to about
72 hours to complete.
[0241] Step c: A compound of formula (6) can be prepared by reacting a compound of formula
(4), X
1 being preferably bromo or iodo, with R
1-Z
1, wherein R
1 is as defined herein, Z
1 being preferably a boronic acid or ester (Suzuki reaction), in the presence of a
suitable solvent (for example dimethoxyethane, or a mixture of dimethoxyethane and
water, or the like), a suitable inorganic base (for example sodium carbonate, or the
like), and a palladium catalyst (for example bis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(II)
dichloride, or 1,1'-bis(diphenylphosphino)ferrocene-palladium(II)dichloride dichloromethane
complex, or tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0), or the like) and optionally
a cosolvent (for example, ethanol, or the like. The reaction takes place from about
80°C to about 130°C and can take from about 20 minutes to about 18 hours to complete.
[0242] Alternatively, step c can occur by reacting a compound of formula (4), X
1 being preferably bromo or iodo, with R
1-Z
2, wherein R
1 is as defined herein, Z
2 being preferably a trialkylstannyl reagent (Stille reaction), in the presence of
a suitable solvent (for example dimethyl sulfoxide, or the like), and a palladium
catalyst (for example tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0). The reaction takes
place at about 140°C and can take up to about 18 hours to complete.
[0243] Step d: A compound of formula (I) can be prepared by reacting a compound of formula
(5), X
1 being preferably bromo or iodo, with R
1-Z
1, wherein R
1 is as defined herein, Z
1 being preferably a boronic acid or ester (Suzuki reaction), in the presence of a
suitable solvent (for example dimethoxyethane, or a mixture of dimethoxyethane and
water, or the like), a inorganic base (for example sodium carbonate, or the like),
and a palladium catalyst (for example bis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(II) dichloride,
or 1,1'-bis(diphenylphosphino)ferrocene-palladium(II)dichloride dichloromethane complex,
or tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0), or the like) and optionally a cosolvent
(for example, ethanol, or the like). The reaction takes place at about 80-130°C and
can take up to about 20 minutes to 2 hours to complete.
[0244] Step e: A compound of formula (I) can be prepared by reacting a compound of formula
(6) with R
2-H wherein R
2 is as defined herein, in the presence of a suitable solvent (for example 2-propanol,
or dimethyl sulfoxide, or the like), an organic base (for example diisopropylethylamine,
or triethylamine, or the like). The reaction takes place at about 90-140°C and can
take up to about 30 minutes to 72 hours to complete.
[0245] Compounds of formula (I) can be prepared by proceeding as in the following Reaction
Scheme II:

in which Y, Y
1, R
1, R
2, R
3 and R
4 are as defined for formula (I) in the Summary of the Invention and X
1 and X
2 represent halogen atoms, X
1 in particular chloro, bromo, or iodo, X
2 in particular chloro or fluoro and Alk is low alkyl chain in particular methyl.
[0246] Step f: A compound of formula (8) can be prepared by reacting a compound of formula
(7) with R
2-H wherein R
2 is as defined herein, in analogy to Step b
[0247] Step g: A compound of formula (9) can be prepared by reacting a compound of formula
(8), X
1 being preferably bromo or iodo, with R
1-Z
1, where R
1 is as defined herein, Z
1 being preferably a boronic acid or ester (Suzuki reaction), in analogy to Step d.
[0248] Step h: A compound of formula (10) can be prepared by hydrolysis of the ester of
a compound of formula (9) in the presence of a suitable solvent (for example water,
or the like), an inorganic base (for example sodium hydroxide, or the like). The reaction
takes place at room temperature and can take up to about 2 hours complete.
[0249] Step i: A compound of formula (I) can be prepared by reacting a compound of formula
(10) with a compound of formula (3) in the presence of a coupling reagent (such as
1-ethyl-3-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)carbodiimide hydrochloride and hydroxybenzotriazole,
or the like), a suitable base (such as N-methylmorpholine, diisopropylethylamine,
or the like) and a suitable solvent (such as dichloromethane, dimethylformamide, or
the like). The reaction takes place at room temperature and can take up to about 12
hours to complete.
[0250] Compounds of formula (I) can be prepared by proceeding as in the following Reaction
Scheme III:

in which Y, Y
1, R
1, R
2, R
3 and R
4 are as defined for formula (I) in the Summary of the Invention and X
1 and X
2 represent halogen atoms, X
1 in particular chloro, bromo, or iodo, X
2 in particular chloro or fluoro, Prot represents a protecting group, in particular
tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl (THP) or 2-(trimethylsilyl)ethoxy]methyl (SEM) when R
1 is pyrazole with free NH.
[0251] Step 1: A compound of formula (12) can be prepared by reacting a compound of formula
(4) with Prot-R
1-Z
1 where R
1 is as defined herein, Z
1 being preferably a boronic acid or ester (Suzuki reaction), Prot is in particular
THP or SEM, in analogy to Step c.
[0252] Step m: A compound of formula (13) can be prepared by reacting a compound of formula
(12) with R
2-H wherein R
2 is as defined herein, in analogy to Step e.
[0253] Step n: A compound of formula (13) can be prepared by reacting a compound of formula
(5) with Prot-R
1-Z
1 where R
1 is as defined herein, Z
1 being preferably a boronic acid or ester (Suzuki reaction), Prot is in particular
THP or SEM, in analogy to Step d.
[0254] Step o: A compound of formula (I) can be prepared by reacting a compound of formula
(13) with a deprotecting agent (for example tetra-n-butylammonium fluoride, or trifluoacetic
acid, or hydrochloric acid, or the like) in the presence of a suitable solvent (for
example tetrahydrofuran, or dichloromethane, or the like). The reaction takes place
at room temperature or to about 80°C and can take up to about 2 to 24 hours to complete.
[0255] Compounds of formula (I), where R
1 is a pyrazole substituted by a R
6 group, can be prepared by proceeding as in the following Reaction Scheme IV:

in which Y, Y
1, R
2, R
3, R
4 and R
6 are as defined for formula (I) in the Summary of the Invention and X
1 represents an halogen atom, in particular bromo, or iodo, and R
6 being lower alkyl, in particular methyl.
[0256] Step p: A compound of formula (14) can be prepared by reacting a compound of formula
(5) with an alkylvinylketon (for example methylvinylketon, or the like) in the presence
of a suitable solvent (for example dimethylformamide, or the like), an organic base
(for example triethylamine, or the like), and a palladium catalyst (for example tri-o-tolylphosphine-palladium
diacetate, or the like). The reaction takes place at about 130°C and can take up to
16 hours to complete.
[0257] Step q: A compound of formula (Id) can be prepared by reacting a compound of formula
(14) by reacting with a protected hydrazide (for example toluene-4-sulfonic acid hydrazide,
or the like) in the presence of a suitable solvent (for example ethanol, or the like),
The reaction takes place at about 80°C and can take up to 2 hours to complete. Then
the protecting group is removed in situ with an alcoholate (for example sodium methoxyde,
or the like). The deprotection takes place at about 80°C and can take up to 48 hours
to complete.
[0258] Compounds of formula (I) can be prepared by proceeding as in the following Reaction
Scheme V:

in which Y, Y
1, R
1, R
2, R
3 and R
4 are as defined for formula (I) in the Summary of the Invention, X
1 and X
2 represent halogen atoms, X
1 in particular chloro, bromo, or iodo, X
2 in particular chloro or fluoro and Alk is low alkyl chain in particular methyl, Prot
represents a protecting group, in particular tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl (THP) when R
1 is pyrazole with free NH.
[0259] Step r: A compound of formula (15) can be prepared by reacting a compound of formula
(8), X
1 being preferably bromo or iodo, with Prot-R
1-Z
1, where R
1 is as defined herein, Prot is in particular tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl (THP) when R
1 is pyrazole with free NH, Z
1 being preferably a boronic acid or ester (Suzuki reaction), in analogy to Step d.
[0260] Step s: A compound of formula (16) can be prepared by hydrolysis of the ester of
a compound of formula (15) in the presence of a suitable solvent (for example water
and methanol, or the like), an inorganic base (for example sodium hydroxide, or the
like). The reaction takes place at room temperature and can take up to about 14 hours
complete.
[0261] Step t: A compound of formula (17) can be prepared by reacting a compound of (16)
with a compound of formula (3) in the presence of a coupling reagent (such as 1-ethyl-3-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)carbodiimide
hydrochloride and hydroxybenzotriazole, or the like), a suitable base (such as N-methylmorpholine,
or the like) and a suitable solvent (such as tetrahydrofuran, or the like). The reaction
takes place at about 25°-65°C and can take up to about 2 days to complete.
[0262] Step u: A compound of formula (I) can be prepared by reacting a compound of formula
(17) with a deprotecting agent (for example hydrochloric acid, or the like) in the
presence of a suitable solvent (for example tetrahydrofuran and methanol, or the like).
The reaction takes place at room temperature about 2 hours to complete.
[0263] Detailed examples of the synthesis of compounds of formula (I) can be found in the
Examples,
infra.
Additional Processes for Making Compounds of the Invention
[0264] A compound of the invention can be prepared as a pharmaceutically acceptable acid
addition salt by reacting the free base form of the compound with a pharmaceutically
acceptable inorganic or organic acid. Alternatively, a pharmaceutically acceptable
base addition salt of a compound of the invention can be prepared by reacting the
free acid form of the compound with a pharmaceutically acceptable inorganic or organic
base.
[0265] Compounds of the formula (I) can also be modified by appending appropriate functionalities
to enhance selective biological properties. Modifications of this kind are known in
the art and include those that increase penetration into a given biological system
(
e.g. blood, lymphatic system, central nervous system, testis), increase bioavailability,
increase solubility to allow parenteral administration (
e.g. injection, infusion), alter metabolism and/or alter the rate of secretion. Examples
of this type of modifications include but are not limited to esterification,
e.g. with polyethylene glycols, derivatisation with pivaloyloxy or fatty acid substituents,
conversion to carbamates, hydroxylation of aromatic rings and heteroatom substitution
in aromatic rings. Whereever compounds of the formula (I), and/or N-oxides, tautomers
and/or (preferably pharmaceutically acceptable) salts thereof are mentioned, this
comprises such modified formulae, while preferably the molecules of the formula (I),
their N-oxides, their tautomers and/or their salts are meant.
[0266] Alternatively, the salt forms of the compounds of the invention can be prepared using
salts of the starting materials or intermediates. In view of the close relationship
between the novel compounds of the formula (I) in free form and those in the form
of their salts, including those salts that can be used as intermediates, for example
in the purification or identification of the novel compounds, any reference to the
compounds or a compound of the formula (I) hereinbefore and hereinafter is to be understood
as referring to the compound in free form and/or also to one or more salts thereof,
as appropriate and expedient, as well as to one or more solvates,
e.g. hydrates.
[0267] Salts are formed, for example, as acid addition salts, preferably with organic or
inorganic acids, from compounds of formula (I) with a basic nitrogen atom, especially
the pharmaceutically acceptable salts. Suitable inorganic acids are, for example,
halogen acids, such as hydrochloric acid, sulfuric acid, or phosphoric acid. Suitable
organic acids are, for example, carboxylic, phosphonic, sulfonic or sulfamic acids,
for example acetic acid, propionic acid, octanoic acid, decanoic acid, dodecanoic
acid, glycolic acid, lactic acid, fumaric acid, succinic acid, malonic acid, adipic
acid, pimelic acid, suberic acid, azelaic acid, malic acid, tartaric acid, citric
acid, amino acids, such as glutamic acid or aspartic acid, maleic acid, hydroxymaleic
acid, methylmaleic acid, cyclohexanecarboxylic acid, adamantanecarboxylic acid, benzoic
acid, salicylic acid, 4-aminosalicylic acid, phthalic acid, phenylacetic acid, mandelic
acid, cinnamic acid, methane- or ethane-sulfonic acid, 2-hydroxyethanesulfonic acid,
ethane-1,2-disulfonic acid, benzenesulfonic acid, 4-toluenesulfonic acid, 2-naphthalenesulfonic
acid, 1,5-naphthalene-disulfonic acid, 2- or 3-methylbenzenesulfonic acid, methylsulfuric
acid, ethylsulfuric acid, dodecylsulfuric acid, N-cyclohexylsulfamic acid, N-methyl-,
N-ethyl- or N-propyl-sulfamic acid, or other organic protonic acids, such as ascorbic
acid. Salts can usually be converted to free compounds,
e.g. by treating with suitable basic compounds, for example with alkali metal carbonates,
alkali metal hydrogencarbonates, or alkali metal hydroxides, typically potassium carbonate
or sodium hydroxide.
[0268] For isolation or purification purposes it is also possible to use pharmaceutically
unacceptable salts, for example picrates or perchlorates. For therapeutic use, only
pharmaceutically acceptable salts or free compounds are employed (where applicable
in the form of pharmaceutical preparations), and these are therefore preferred.
[0269] The free acid or free base forms of the compounds of the invention can be prepared
from the corresponding base addition salt or acid addition salt from, respectively.
For example a compound of the invention in an acid addition salt form can be converted
to the corresponding free base by treating with a suitable base (
e.g., ammonium hydroxide solution, sodium hydroxide, and the like). A compound of the
invention in a base addition salt form can be converted to the corresponding free
acid by treating with a suitable acid (
e.g., hydrochloric acid, etc.).
[0270] Compounds of the invention in unoxidized form can be prepared from N-oxides of compounds
of the invention by treating with a reducing agent (
e.g., sulfur, sulfur dioxide, triphenyl phosphine, lithium borohydride, sodium borohydride,
phosphorus trichloride, tribromide, or the like) in a suitable inert organic solvent
(
e.g. acetonitrile, ethanol, aqueous dioxane, or the like) at 0 to 80°C.
[0271] Prodrug derivatives of the compounds of the invention can be prepared by methods
known to those of ordinary skill in the art (
e.g., for further details see
Saulnier MG, Langley DR, Kadow JF, Senter PD, Knipe JO, Tun MM, Vyas DM and Doyle
TW (1994) Synthesis of etoposide phosphate, BMY-4048 1: a watersoluble clinically
active prodrug of etoposide. Bioorg Med Chem Lett 4:2567-2572; and
Rautio J, Kumpulainen H, Heimbach T, Oliyai R, Oh D, Järvinen T and Savolainen J
(2008); Prodrugs: design and clinical applications. Nat Rev Drug Discov. 7:255-70). For example, a compound of the invention can form a phosphate ester of a hydroxyl
group. More specifically, a compound of the invention can form a prodrug as shown:

[0272] Further, a compound of the invention can be a prodrug of another compound of the
invention. To illustrate, example 36 is a prodrug of example 37 and example 37 is
a potential metabolite of example 36.
[0273] Protected derivatives of the compounds of the invention can be made by means known
to those of ordinary skill in the art. If one or more other functional groups, for
example carboxy, hydroxy, amino, sulfhydryl or the like are or need to be protected
in a starting material as described herein or any other precursor, because they should
not take part in the reaction or disturb the reaction, these are such groups as are
usually used in the synthesis of peptide compounds, and also of cephalosporins and
penicillins, as well as nucleic acid derivatives and sugars. Protecting groups are
such groups that are no longer present in the final compounds once they are removed,
while groups that remain as substituents are not protecting groups in the sense used
here which are groups that are added at a starting material or intermediate stage
and removed to obtain a final compound. Also in the case of conversions of a compound
of the formula (I) into a different compound of the formula (I), protecting groups
may be introduced and removed, if useful or required. The protecting groups may already
be present in precursors and should protect the functional groups concerned against
unwanted secondary reactions, such as acylations, etherifications, esterifications,
oxidations, solvolysis, and similar reactions. It is a characteristic of protecting
groups that they lend themselves readily, i.e. without undesired secondary reactions,
to removal, typically by acetolysis, protonolysis, solvolysis, reduction, photolysis
or also by enzyme activity, for example under conditions analogous to physiological
conditions, and that they are not present in the end-products. The specialist knows,
or can easily establish, which protecting groups are suitable with the reactions mentioned
above and below.
[0274] The protection of such functional groups by such protecting groups, the protecting
groups themselves, and their removal reactions are described for example in standard
reference works, such as
J. F. W. McOmie, "Protective Groups in Organic Chemistry", Plenum Press, London and
New York 1973, in
T. W. Greene, "Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis", Third edition, Wiley, New
York 1999, in "
The Peptides"; Volume 3 (editors: E. Gross and J. Meienhofer), Academic Press, London
and New York 1981, in
"Methoden der organischen Chemie" (Methods of organic chemistry), Houben Weyl, 4th
edition, Volume 15/1, Georg Thieme Verlag, Stuttgart 1974, in
H.-D. Jakubke and H. Jescheit, "Aminosäuren, Peptide, Proteine" (Amino acids, peptides,
proteins), Verlag Chemie, Weinheim, Deerfield Beach, and Basel 1982, and in
Jochen Lehmann, "Chemie der Kohlenhydrate: Monosaccharide und Derivate" (Chemistry
of carbohydrates: monosaccharides and derivatives), Georg Thieme Verlag, Stuttgart
1974.
[0275] Compounds of the present invention can be conveniently prepared, or formed during
the process of the invention, as solvates (
e.g., hydrates). Hydrates of compounds of the present invention can be conveniently prepared
by recrystallization from an aqueous/organic solvent mixture, using organic solvents
such as dioxin, tetrahydrofuran or methanol.
[0276] Compounds of the invention can be prepared as their individual stereoisomers by reacting
a racemic mixture of the compound with an optically active resolving agent to form
a pair of diastereoisomeric compounds, separating the diastereomers and recovering
the optically pure enantiomers. While resolution of enantiomers can be carried out
using covalent diastereomeric derivatives of the compounds of the invention, dissociable
complexes are preferred (
e.g., crystalline diastereomeric salts). Diastereomers have distinct physical properties
(
e.g., melting points, boiling points, solubilities, reactivity, etc.) and can be readily
separated by taking advantage of these dissimilarities. Diastereomeric mixtures for
example may be separated into their individual diastereomers by means of fractionated
crystallization, chromatography, solvent distribution, and similar procedures. This
separation may take place either at the level of a starting compound or in a compound
of formula (I) itself. Enantiomers may be separated through the formation of diastereomeric
salts, for example by salt formation with an enantiomer-pure chiral acid, or by means
of chromatography, for example by HPLC, using chromatographic substrates with chiral
ligands. The optically pure enantiomer is then recovered, along with the resolving
agent, by any practical means that would not result in racemization. A more detailed
description of the techniques applicable to the resolution of stereoisomers of compounds
from their racemic mixture can be found in
Jean Jacques, Andre Collet, Samuel H. Wilen, "Enantiomers, Racemates and Resolutions",
John Wiley And Sons, Inc., 1981.
[0277] In summary, the compounds of formula (I) can be made by a process, which involves:
- (a) those of reaction schemes I-V; and
- (b) optionally converting a compound of the invention into a pharmaceutically acceptable
salt;
- (c) optionally converting a salt form of a compound of the invention to a non-salt
form;
- (d) optionally converting an unoxidized form of a compound of the invention into a
pharmaceutically acceptable N-oxide;
- (e) optionally converting an N-oxide form of a compound of the invention to its unoxidized
form;
- (f) optionally resolving an individual isomer of a compound of the invention from
a mixture of isomers;
- (g) optionally converting a non-derivatized compound of the invention into a pharmaceutically
acceptable prodrug derivative; and
- (h) optionally converting a prodrug derivative of a compound of the invention to its
non-derivatized form.
[0278] Insofar as the production of the starting materials is not particularly described,
the compounds are known or can be prepared analogously to methods known in the art
or as disclosed in the Examples hereinafter.
[0279] One of skill in the art will appreciate that the above transformations are only representative
of methods for preparation of the compounds of the present invention, and that other
well known methods can similarly be used.
Examples
[0280] The following Examples illustrate the invention without limiting the scope thereof.
In the Examples provided, temperatures are given in degrees Celsius. Unless otherwise
indicated, the reactions take place at room temperature. Further, if not indicated
otherwise, the analytical HPLC conditions are as follows:
Condition 1: UPLC-MS, column Acquity BEH C18, 1.7 µm, 2.1 x 50 mm, oven at 40°C, eluents: A =
water + 0.1% formic acid and B = MeCN + 0.1% formic acid, gradient from 20% to 100%
B in 4.3 min, flow 0.7 mL/min, detection UV/VIS (DAD), ESI (+/-).
Condition 2: LC-MS, column Ascentis® Express C18 2.7 µm 2.1 x 30 mm, 50°C, eluents: A = water
+ 0.05 % formic acid + 3.75 mM ammonium acetate and B = MeCN + 0.04% formic acid,
gradient from 5% to 95% B in 3.7 min, flow 1.2 mL/min to 1.4 mL/min in 3.7 min, detection
UV/VIS (DAD), ESI (+/-).
Condition 3: UPLC-MS, column Acquity HSS T3, 1.8 µm, 2.1 x 50 mm, oven at 50°C, eluents: A =
water + 0.05% formic acid + 3.75 mM ammonium acetate and B = MeCN + 0.04% formic acid,
gradient from 2% to 98% B in 1.40 min, then 98% B for 0.75 min, flow 1.2 mL/min, detection
UV/VIS (DAD), ESI (+/-).
Condition 4: HPLC, column Chromolith® Performance, RP-18e, 100 x 4.6 mm + precolumn 5 x 4.6 mm
at RT, eluents: A = water + 0.1% formic acid and B = MeCN + 0.1% formic acid, gradient
from 2% to 100% B in 8 min, then 100 % B for 2 min, flow 2.0 mL/min, detection UV/VIS
(DAD).
Condition 5: HPLC, column CC125/4 Nucleosil® 100-3 C18HD, 4.0 x 125 mm, eluents: A = water +
0.1% TFA and B = MeCN + 0.1% TFA, gradient from 2% to 100% B in 7 min, then 100% B
for 2 min and finally 100% to 2% B in 1 min, flow 1.0 mL/min, detection UV 215 nm.
Condition 6: similar condition as Condition 3, oven at 60°C instead of 50°C.
Condition 7: : HPLC, column Eclipse XDB C18, 5 µm, 4.6 x 150 mm, oven at 25°C, eluents: A = water
+ 0.1% H3PO4 and B = MeCN, gradient from 10% to 95% B in 17 min, flow 1.0 mL/min, detection UV/VIS
(DAD) 210 nm.
Condition 8: LC-MS, column Poroshell® 120 SB-C18, 3.0 x 50 mm, 2.7 µm, eluents: A = water + 0.1%
TFA and B = MeCN + 0.1% TFA, gradient from 5% B for 0.5 min, 5% to 95% B in 6.5 min,
95% B for 3 min, 95% to 5% B in 0.1 min, 5% B for 2 min, flow 0.8 mL/min, UV/VIS (DAD),
ESI (+).
Further, if not indicated otherwise, the preparative HPLC conditions are as follows:
Condition 9: Preparative HPLC, Column: XBridge C18 30 x 100 mm, 5 µm; flow rate 30 mL/min; mobile
phase: A = water + 0.1% formic acid; B = MeCN; variable gradient, from initial % B
to final % B, and runtime as specified in the Examples.
Condition 10: Preparative HPLC Gilson system, column SunFire™ prep C18 OBD, 5 µm 30 x 100 mm, eluents:
A = water + 0.1 % TFA and B = MeCN, gradient 5% B for 2 min, then 5% to 100% B in
20 min and finally 100% B in 3 min, flow 30 mL/min, detection UV/VIS.
[0281] Preparative achiral SFC is done using the following system: Waters SFC THAR100; flow
rate 100 mL / min; mobile phase: A = supercritical CO
2; B = MeOH; variable gradient, from initial % B to final % B runtime and columns as
specified in the Examples. Details for the columns:
Column DEAP: column Diethyl amino (250 x 30 mm, 5 µm, 60 Å), Princeton
Column Diol: column Diol (250 x 30 mm, 5 µm, 60 Å), Princeton
1H-NMR spectra were recorded on a 300 MHz, or a 400 MHz NMR spectrometer as indicated.
Significant peaks are tabulated in the order: multiplicity (s, singlet; d, doublet;
t, triplet; q, quartet; m, multiplet; br. s, broad singlet) and number of protons.
[0282] In the following Examples, the abbreviations given below are used: aq. (aqueous);
DAD (diode array detector); DCM (dichloromethane); DIPEA (diisopropyl-ethylamine);
DMF (N,N-dimethylformamide); DME (dimethoxyethane); DMSO (dimethyl sulfoxide); dppf
(1,1'-bis(diphenylphosphino)ferrocene); eq. (equivalents); ESI (electrospray ionization);
EtOAc (ethyl acetate); EtOH (ethanol); Et
2O (diethyl ether); h (hour); HPLC (high performance liquid chromatography); HV (high
vacuum); iPrOH (isopropanol); iPr
2O (diisopropyl ether); LC (liquid chromatography); M (molar); MeCN (acetonitrile);
MeOH (methanol); MeTHF (2-methyltetrahydrofuran); min (minutes); mL (milliliters);
MP (macroporous); MPLC (medium pressure liquid chromatography); MS (mass spectrometry);
MW (microwave); n-BuLi (n-butyllithium); NMM (N-methylmorpholine); NMP (N-methylpyrrolidinone);
NMR (nuclear magnetic resonance); PL (polystyrene); PPh
3 (triphenylphosphine); PTFE (polytetrafluorethylene); RM (reaction mixture); RT (room
temperature); sat. (saturated); sec (seconds); SFC (supercritical fluid chromatography);
Si-Thiol (3-mercaptopropyl modified silica gel); SPE (solid phase extraction); TBAF
(tetra-n-butylammonium fluoride); TBME (methyl tert-butyl ether); TFA (trifluoroacetic
acid); THF (tetrahydrofuran); t
R (retention time); UPLC (ultra performance liquid chromatography) and UV (Ultraviolet).
Example 1
(R)-4-(3-Hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-3-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)benzamide
[0283]

[0284] (R)-4-(3-Hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-3-(1-((2-(trimethylsilyl)ethoxy)methyl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)benzamide
(
Stage 1.1, 149 mg, 0.2 mmol) was added to a MW vial, which was sealed and flushed with argon.
A solution of 1 M TBAF in THF (2.98 mL, 2.98 mmol) was then added and the RM was stirred
at 80°C for 3 days. The RM was diluted with EtOAc (40 mL), washed with sat. NaHCO
3 and brine, dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure. The crude product was
purified by preparative SFC (Column DEAP, from 25% to 30% in 6 min) to yield the title
compound as a white solid. UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.98 min, m/z = 433.3 [M+H]
+, m/z = 431.3 [M-H]
-;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.75 (br. s, 1 H) 1.86 (br. s, 1 H) 2.70 - 2.79 (m, 1 H) 3.03 - 3.19 (m, 2
H) 3.19 - 3.28 (m, 1 H) 4.20 (br. s, 1 H) 4.73 - 4.92 (m, 1 H) 6.34 (d, J = 11.00
Hz, 1 H) 6.73 - 6.94 (m, 1 H) 7.32 (d, J = 8.80 Hz, 2 H) 7.65 (d, J = 104.42 Hz, 1
H) 7.81 - 7.96 (m, 4 H) 10.10 (s, 1 H) 12.88 (d, J = 81.67 Hz, 1 H).
Stage 1.1: (R)-4-(3-Hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-3-(1-((2-(trimethylsilyl)ethoxy)methyl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)benzamide
[0285]

[0286] A suspension of (R)-3-bromo-4-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)benzamide
(
Stage 1.2, 100 mg, 0.225 mmol), 5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1-((2-(trimethylsilyl)ethoxy)methyl)-1H-pyrazole
(146 mg, 0.45 mmol), Pd(PPh
3)
2Cl
2 (17.34 mg, 0.025 mmol) and Na
2CO
3 (119 mg, 1.123 mmol) in a mixture of water (272 µL), DME (953 µL) and EtOH (136 µL)
was subjected to MW irradiation at 125°C for 20 min. The RM was diluted with THF (3
mL), treated with Si-Thiol (Silicycle, 1.44 mmol/g, 94 mg, 0.135 mmol), filtered and
the filtrate was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a residue which was
purified by flash chromatography (RediSep® Silica gel column, 4 g, cyclohexane / EtOAc
from 40% to 100% EtOAc) to yield the title compound as a yellow oil. UPLC-MS (Condition
1) t
R = 3.28 min, m/z = 563.2 [M+H]
+, m/z = 561.2 [M-H]
-.
Stage 1.2: (R)-3-Bromo-4-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)benzamide
[0287]

[0288] A mixture of 3-bromo-4-fluoro-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)benzamide (
Stage 1.3, 100 mg, 0.264 mmol), (R)-pyrrolidin-3-ol (46.1 mg, 0.529 mmol) and TEA (147 µL, 1.058
mmol) in DMSO (199 µL) was stirred at 90°C for 16 h. The RM was diluted with TBME/EtOAc
(1:1) (30 mL), washed with 0.5 M HCl (3 x 5 mL) and brine (5 mL) and the solvent was
evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a crude product that was purified by
flash chromatography (RediSep® Silica gel column, 4 g, cyclohexane / EtOAc-EtOH +
0.1% NH
4OH (8:2), from 30% to 80% EtOAc-EtOH + 0.1% NH
4OH (8:2)) to yield the title compound as an off-white solid. UPLC-MS (Condition 1)
t
R = 2.83 min, m/z = 444.9/446.9 [M+H]
+, m/z = 443.0/445.0 [M-H]
-;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.80 - 1.92 (m, 1 H) 1.92 - 2.04 (m, 1 H) 3.24 - 3.30 (m, 1 H). 3.36 - 3.46
(m, 1 H) 3.60 - 3.72 (m, 1 H) 3.81 (dd, J = 10.51, 4.65 Hz, 1 H) 4.36 (d, J = 2.69
Hz, 1 H) 4.97 (d, J = 3.42 Hz, 1 H) 6.93 (d, J = 8.80 Hz, 1 H) 7.34 (d, J = 8.56 Hz,
2 H) 7.80 - 7.90 (m, 3 H) 8.14 (d, J = 1.96 Hz, 1 H) 10.19 (s, 1 H).
Stage 1.3: 3-Bromo-4-fluoro-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)benzamide
[0289]

[0290] SOCl
2 (2.92 mL, 40.0 mmol) and DMF (0.5 mL) were added dropwise to a suspension of 3-bromo-4-fluorobenzoic
acid (1.752 g, 8 mmol) in toluene (20 mL) and the RM was stirred at 80°C for 1 h The
solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure and the residue was diluted with
THF (15 mL). DIPEA (2.79 mL, 16.00 mmol) was added and the mixture was cooled to 0°C,
treated with a solution of 4-trifluoromethoxyaniline (1.181 mL, 8.80 mmol) in THF
(5 mL) and stirred for 1 h. The RM was treated with aq. 1 M HCl (50 mL), and extracted
with TBME. The combined extracts were washed with aq. 1 M HCl, aq. 1 M NaOH and brine,
dried over MgSO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a residue was crystallized
from n-heptane / DCM to afford the title compound as a white solid. UPLC-MS (Condition
1) t
R = 3.18 min, m/z = 377.9/379.9 [M+H]
+, m/z = 375.9/377.9 [M-H]
-;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 7.38 (d, J = 8.6 Hz, 2 H) 7.56 (t, J = 8.7 Hz, 1 H) 7.87 (d, J = 9.0 Hz, 2
H) 8.00 - 8.06 (m, 1 H) 8.32 (dd, J = 6.6, 2.2 Hz, 1 H) 10.50 (s, 1 H).
Example 2
(R)-6-(3-Hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-3-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0291]

[0292] A mixture of DME (570 µL), water (163 µL) and EtOH (81 µL) was added to a mixture
of (R)-5-bromo-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 2.2, 60 mg, 0.134 mmol), (1H-pyrazol-3-yl)boronic acid (45.1 mg, 0.403 mmol) Pd(PPh
3)
2Cl
2 (9.44 mg, 0.013 mmol), Na
2CO
3 (42.8 mg, 0.403 mmol) in a MW vial. The vial was sealed, evacuated / purged 3 times
with argon and the RM was subjected to MW irradiation at 120°C for 10 min. Additional
(1H-pyrazol-3-yl)boronic acid (45.1 mg, 0.403 mmol) was added and the RM was subjected
to MW irradiation at 120°C for 30 min, diluted with THF (1 mL) and treated with Si-Thiol
(Silicycle 1.27 mmol/g, 52.9 mg, 0.067 mmol), filtered and the filtrate was evaporated
off under reduced pressure to give a residue which was purified by preparative HPLC
(Condition 9, 15% for 0.2 min then 15% to 45% in 14 min) to yield the title compound
as a white solid.
[0293] Alternatively,
Example 2 was prepared by treating a suspension of 6-((R)-3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
(Stage 2.1, 68.3 g, 132 mmol) in DCM (1 L) with TFA (305 mL, 3959 mmol) at RT for 5.5 h. The
solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure and the residue was dissolved in
EtOAc (2 L), washed with a sat. solution of NaHCO
3 (3 x 500 mL) and brine (2 x 500 mL),and dried over Na
2SO
4. The solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure and the residue was suspended
in DCM (300 mL) and stirred at RT for 15 min. The crystalline material was filtered,
washed with DCM (200 mL), dried under reduced pressure, dissolved in MeOH (500mL)
and treated with Si-Thiol (Biotage, 10.0 g, 13 mmol) for 15 h at 30°C. The mixture
was filtered and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give the
crude product which was purified by flash chromatography (Silica gel, 2 kg, DCM /
MeOH 95:5) and crystallized from MeCN to afford the title compound as a white crystalline
solid.
[0294] Analytical data for
Example 2: HPLC (Condition 5) t
R = 5.37 min, HPLC Chiral (CHIRALPAK® AD-H, 250 x 4.6 mm, eluent: EtOH/MeCN (98:2),
0.5 mL/min, UV 210 nm) t
R = 9.62 min, UPLC-MS (condition 1) t
R = 1.79 min, m/z = 434.1/435.1 [M+H]
+, m/z = 432.1/433.1 [M-H]
-;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.65 - 1.76 (m, 1 H) 1.76 - 1.87 (m, 1 H) 2.97 (d, J=11.37 Hz, 1 H) 3.19 -
3.29 (m, 2 H) 3.34 - 3.48 (m, 1 H) 4.10 - 4.23 (m, 1 H) 4.89 (br. s, 1 H) 6.40 (s,
1 H) 7.33 (d, J=8.70 Hz, 2 H) 7.58/7.82 (br. s, 1 H) 7.89 (d, J=8.70 Hz, 2 H) 8.06
(s, 1 H) 8.77 (s, 1 H) 10.21 (s, 1 H) 12.88/13.07 (br. s, 1 H).
Stage 2.1: 6-((R)-3-Hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0295]

[0296] 1-(Tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-5-boronic acid pinacol ester (59.9 g, 214.4
mmol), K
3PO
4 (105.7 g, 498.1 mmol) and Pd(PPh
3)
4 (9.6 g, 8.30 mmol) were added to a suspension of (R)-5-bromo-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 2.2, 74 g, 165.8 mmol) in toluene (740 mL) and stirred at 110°C for 2.5 h under argon.
The mixture was then diluted with EtOAc (2 L),washed with water (2 x 1 L) and dried
over Na
2SO
4. The solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure and the crude residue was
purified by flash chromatography (Silica gel, 2 kg, DCM / MeOH 95:5). The resulting
material was dissolved in a mixture of MeOH (500 mL) and THF (800 mL) and was treated
with Si-Thiol (Biotage, 15 g, 19.5 mmol) at RT for 17 h. The mixture was filtered
and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a residue which
was crystallized from MeOH to give the title compound as a white crystalline solid.
HPLC (Condition 5) t
R = 5.99 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 6) m/z = 518.2 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.42 (br. s, 3 H) 1.63 - 1.98 (m, 4 H) 2.20 - 2.37 (m, 1 H) 2.71 - 2.94 (m,
1 H) 3.21 (d, J=6.65 Hz, 3 H) 3.32 - 3.51 (m, 1 H) 3.69 - 3.92 (m, 1 H) 4.08 - 4.24
(m, 1 H) 4.75 - 4.88 (m, 1 H) 4.89 - 5.17 (m, 1 H) 6.29 - 6.49 (m, 1 H) 7.32 (d, J=8.99
Hz, 2 H) 7.59 (s, 1 H) 7.78 - 8.10 (m, 3 H) 8.80 (t, J=2.54 Hz, 1 H) 10.05 - 10.28
(m, 1 H).
Stage 2.2: (R)-5-Bromo-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0297]

[0298] (R)-Pyrrolidin-3-ol (17.1 ml, 211.2 mmol) and DIPEA (67.6 ml, 387.6 mmol) were added
to a suspension of 5-bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide (
Stage 2.3, 69.6 g, 175.9 mmol) in iPrOH (120 mL) and stirred at 140 °C for 1 h. The mixture
was diluted with EtOAc (1 L), washed with IN HCl (2 x 200 mL), a sat. solution of
NaHCO
3 (200 mL) and brine (2 x 200 mL) and dried over Na
2SO
4. The solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure and the product was crystallized
from EtOAc / iPr
2O to afford the title compound as a white crystalline solid. HPLC (Condition 5) t
R = 6.58 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 6) m/z = 446.0/448.0 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.78 - 2.01 (m, 2 H) 3.55 (d, J=11.34 Hz, 1 H) 3.64 - 3.76 (m, 1 H) 3.79 -
3.91 (m, 2 H) 4.33 (br. s, 1 H) 4.97 (d, J=3.13 Hz, 1 H) 7.33 (d, J=9.38 Hz, 2 H)
7.83 (d, J=8.99 Hz, 2 H) 8.30 - 8.36 (m, 1 H) 8.66 (d, J=2.35 Hz, 1 H) 10.20 (s, 1
H).
Stage 2.3: 5-Bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0299]

[0300] A stirred solution of 5-bromo-6-chloro-nicotinic acid (375 g, 1.586 mol) and DMF
(37 mL) in toluene (3.1 L) was treated dropwise with SOCl
2 (347 mL, 4.758 mol) at RT and then stirred at 85°C for 2.5 h. The solvent was evaporated
off under reduced pressure and the residue was dissolved in THF (3.1 L), cooled to
-25°C, treated firstly with DIPEA (543 mL, 3.172 mol) and then by the dropwise addition
of a solution of 4-(trifluoromethoxy)aniline (295 g, 1.665 mol) in THF (3.1 L), After
30 min at 10°C the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure and the residue
was dissolved in TBME (4 L), washed with IN HCl (2 x 1 L), a sat. solution of NaHCO
3 (1 L) and brine (2 x 200 mL) and dried over Na
2SO
4. The solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure and the product was crystallized
from EtOAc / n-heptane to give the title compound as a beige crystalline solid. UPLC-MS
(Condition 3) t
R = 1.25 min, m/z = 393/395/397 [M-H]
-;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 7.40 (d, J=8.60 Hz, 2 H) 7.86 (d, J=8.60 Hz, 2 H) 8.73 (d, J=2.20 Hz, 1 H)
8.92 (d, J=2.20 Hz, 1 H) 10.69 (s, 1 H).
Example 3
(R)-6-(3-Hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(3-methyl-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0301]

[0302] (R,E)-6-(3-Hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(3-oxobut-1-en-1-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 3.1, 50 mg, 0.091 mmol) and toluene-4-sulfonic acid hydrazide (34.5 mg, 0.181 mmol) and
EtOH (302 µL) were added to a MW vial, which was sealed and stirred at 80°C for 1.5
h. The mixture was cooled to RT, NaOMe (17.15 mg, 0.318 mmol) was added and the RM
was stirred at 80°C for 48 h. Aq. The RM was acidified with aq. formic acid, filtered
through a 0.2 µM PTFE membrane filter and purified by preparative HPLC (Condition
9, from 20% to 50% in 18 min) to yield the title compound as a white solid. UPLC-MS
(Condition 1) t
R = 2.08 min, m/z = 448.0 [M+H]
+, m/z = 446.0 [M-H]
-;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.68 - 1.79 (m, 1 H) 1.78 - 1.90 (m, 1 H) 2.29 (br. s, 3 H) 2.98 (d, J=11.74
Hz, 1 H) 3.25 - 3.37 (m, 2 H) 3.40 - 3.53 (m, 1 H) 4.21 (br. s, 1 H) 4.83 (br. s,
1 H) 6.13 (s, 1 H) 7.33 (d, J=8.31 Hz, 2 H) 7.86 (d, 2 H) 8.01 (br. s, 1 H) 8.71 (br.
s, 1 H) 10.15 (s, 1 H) 12.57 (br. s, 1 H).
Stage 3.1: (R,E)-6-(3-Hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(3-oxobut-1-en-1-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0303]

[0304] (R)-5-Bromo-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
(Stage 2.2, 250 mg, 0.560 mmol), Pd(OAc)
2 (3.77 mg, 0.017 mmol), tri-o-tolylphosphine (20.46 mg, 0.067 mmol), but-3-en-2-one
(55.1 µL, 0.672 mmol) and TEA (102 µL, 0.728 mmol) were added to a MW vial, which
was sealed and purged with argon. DMF (1.87 mL) was added and the RM was stirred at
130°C for 6 h. Additional but-3-en-2-one (22.96 µL, 0.280 mmol) was then added and
mixture was stirred at 130°C for 16 h. The RM was poured into water (25 mL) and extracted
with DCM (3 x 20 mL). The combined extracts were dried over MgSO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give the crude product
which was purified by flash chromatography (RediSep® Silica gel column, 12 g, cyclohexane
/ EtOAc-EtOH + 0.1% NH
4OH (9:1) from 40% to 75% EtOAc-EtOH + 0.1% NH
4OH (9:1)). Fractions containing pure product were combined and the solvent was evaporated
off under reduced pressure to give a residue which was azeotroped with xylene and
triturated in cyclohexane to yield the title compound as a yellow solid. UPLC-MS (Condition
1) t
R = 2.39 min, m/z = 436.0 [M+H]
+, m/z = 434.0 [M-H]
-;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.82 - 1.91 (m, 1 H) 1.91 - 2.00 (m, 1 H) 2.35 (s, 3 H) 3.43 (d, J = 11.25
Hz, 1 H) 3.59 - 3.67 (m, 1 H) 3.78 - 3.88 (m, 2 H) 4.34 (br. s, 1 H) 4.99 (d, J =
3.18 Hz, 1 H) 6.61 (d, J = 15.89 Hz, 1 H) 7.36 (d, J = 8.31 Hz, 2 H) 7.81 - 7.93 (m,
J = 16.14, 9.29 Hz, 3 H) 8.29 (d, J = 2.20 Hz, 1 H) 8.71 (d, J = 2.45 Hz, 1 H) 10.21
(s, 1 H).
Example 4
(R)-6-(3-Hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(4-methyl-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0305]

[0306] DIPEA (43.9 µL, 0.252 mmol) was added to a solution of 6-chloro-5-(4-methyl-1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 4.1, 55 mg, 0114 mmol) and (R)-pyrrolidin-3-ol (11.96 mg, 0.137 mmol) in iPrOH (114 µL)
in a vial, which was sealed and heated at 140°C for 18 h. After cooling to RT, the
RM was dissolved in EtOAc, washed with brine, dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure and the crude product was
purified by flash chromatography (RediSep® Silica gel column, EtOAc / MeOH 98:2) to
afford 6-((R)-3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(4-methyl-1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
as an off-white foam. This intermediate (39 mg, 0.073 mmol) was dissolved in DCM (0.8
mL), treated with TFA (0.262 mL, 3.4 mmol) and stirred at RT for 3 h. The RM was poured
into 25 mL Na
2CO
3 10% and extracted with EtOAc. The combined extracts were dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure and the crude product was
purified by flash chromatography (RediSep® Silica gel column, DCM / MeOH from 2% to
10% MeOH) to afford the title compound as an off-white powder. HPLC (Condition 4)
t
R = 4.46 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.92 min, m/z = 448.4 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.64 - 1.81 (m, 2 H) 1.86 (s, 3 H) 2.78 - 2.97 (m, 1 H) 3.07 - 3.41 (m, 3
H) 4.18 (br. s, 1 H) 4.81 (br. s, 1 H) 7.32 (d, J = 8.60 Hz, 2 H) 7.58 (br. s, 1 H)
7.85 (d, J = 9.38 Hz, 2 H) 7.93 (br. s, 1 H) 8.73 (br. s, 1 H) 10.14 (s, 1 H) 12.63
(br. s, 1 H).
Stage 4.1: 6-Chloro-5-(4-methyl-1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0307]

[0308] K
3PO
4 (127 mg, 0.6 mmol) was added to a solution of 6-chloro-5-iodo-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 4.2, 89 mg, 0.2 mmol) and 4-methyl-1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole
(58.4 mg, 0.2 mmol) in dioxane (1 mL)in a vial which was flushed with argon, heated
to 110°C and then PdCl
2(dppf) (7.32 mg, 0.01 mmol) was added. The vial was sealed and the RM was stirred
under argon at 110°C for 18 h. The RM was cooled to RT, dissolved in EtOAc and washed
with brine. The organic phase was dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure. and the residue was purified
by flash chromatography (RediSep® Silica gel column, n-heptane / EtOAc form 50% to
100% EtOAc) to afford the title compound as a white foam. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 6.24 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.22 min, m/z = 481.2 [M+H]
+.
Stage 4.2: 6-Chloro-5-iodo-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0309]

[0310] DMF (0.13 mL) and SOCl
2 (0.734 mL, 10.05 mmol) were added to a mixture of 6-chloro-5-iodonicotinic acid (1.00
g, 3.35 mmol) and 4-(trifluoromethoxy)aniline (0.623 mg, 3.52 mmol) in toluene (7
mL) and the RM was stirred at 80°C for 1 h. The solvent was evaporated off under reduced
pressure and under argon the residue was dissolved in THF (7.00 mL) and DIPEA (1.17
mL, 6.7 mmol), cooled to -15°C treated dropwise with a solution of 4-(trifluoromethoxy)aniline
(0.476 mL, 3.52 mmol) in THF (7.00 mL) and stirred at RT for 1 h. The solvent was
evaporated off under reduced pressure and the residue treated with aq. IN HCl (30
mL) and extracted with TBME (100 mL). The combined extracts were washed with sat.
aq. Na
2CO
3 (30 mL) and brine (30 mL), dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure until crystallization commenced.
The product was triturated with n-heptane, filtered and dried to afford the title
compound as an off-white solid. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 6.36 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.23 min, m/z = 441.1 [M-H]
-.
Example 5
(R)-5-(4-Fluoro-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0311]

[0312] DIPEA (71.9 µL, 0.412 mmol) was added to a solution of 6-chloro-5-(4-fluoro-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 5.1, 75 mg, 0.187 mmol) and (R)-pyrrolidin-3-ol (19.97 mg, 0.225 mmol) in iPrOH (187 µL)
in a vial which was sealed and heated at 140°C for 1 h. After cooling at RT, the RM
was dissolved in EtOAc and washed with brine, dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give the crude product
which was purified by flash chromatography (RediSep® Silica gel column, DCM / MeOH
from 2% to 10% MeOH) to afford the title compound as a white foam. HPLC (Condition
4) t
R = 4.73 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.93 min, m/z = 452.4 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.64 - 1.95 (m, 2 H) 3.00 (d, J = 11.34 Hz, 1 H) 3.18 - 3.51 (m, 3 H) 4.22
(br. s, 1 H) 4.86 (br. s, 1 H) 7.32 (d, J = 8.60 Hz, 2 H) 7.77 - 8.11 (m, 4 H) 8.76
(br. s, 1 H) 10.17 (s, 1 H) 12.90 (br. s, 1 H).
Stage 5.1: 6-Chloro-5-(4-fluoro-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0313]

[0314] Pd(Ph
3P)
4 (17.33 mg, 0.015 mmol) was added to solution of 6-chloro-5-iodo-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 4.2, 133 mg, 0.3 mmol) and 4-fluoro-5-(tributylstannyl)-1H-pyrazole (101 mg, 0.270 mmol)
in DMSO (1 mL) in a vial under an argon atmosphere. The vial was sealed and the RM
mixture was heated at 100°C for 18 h. After cooling to RT, the RM was dissolved in
EtOAc, washed with brine, dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give the crude product
which was purified by flash chromatography (RediSep® Silica gel column, n-heptane
/ EtOAc from 10% to 50% EtOAc) to afford the title compound as an off-white powder.
HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 5.5 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.05 min, m/z = 399.2 [M-H]
-.
Example 6
(R)-6-(3 -Hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0315]

[0316] A mixture of (R)-5-bromo-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
(Stage 2.2, 60 mg, 0.134 mmol), 1-methyl-4-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole
(42 mg, 0.202 mmol), Pd(PPh
3)
2Cl
2 (9.44 mg, 0.013 mmol), Na
2CO
3 (42.8 mg, 0.403 mmol), DME (570 µL), water (163 µL) and EtOH (81 µL) in a MW vial
was sealed, evacuated / purge with argon and subjected to MW irradiation at 120°C
for 10 min. The RM was diluted with THF (1 mL), treated with Si-Thiol (Silicycle,
1.44 mmol/g, 46.7 mg, 0.067 mmol), filtered and the filtrate was evaporated off under
reduced pressure to give a residue which was purified by preparative HPLC (Condition
9, 25% for 0.2 min then 15% to 45% in 14 min) to yield the title compound as a white
solid. LC-MS (Condition 2) t
R = 1.61 min, m/z = 448.2/449.2 [M+H]
+, m/z = 446.1 [M-H]
-;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.71 - 1.80 (m, 1 H) 1.81 - 1.91 (m, 1 H) 2.98 (d, J = 11.25 Hz, 1 H) 3.25
- 3.39 (m, .2 H) 3.44 - 3.53 (m, 1 H) 3.89 (s, 3 H) 4.22 (s, 1 H) 4.84 (s, 1 H) 7.34
(d, J = 8.56 Hz, 2 H) 7.53 (s, 1 H) 7.84 (d, J = 5.38 Hz, 2 H) 7.86 - 7.88 (m, 1 H)
7.94 (d, J = 2.45 Hz, 1 H) 8.67 (d, J = 2.45 Hz, 1 H) 10.14 (s, 1 H).
Example 7
(S)-6-(3-(Hydroxymethyl)pyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0317]

[0318] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that of
Example 2 using (S)-5-bromo-6-(3-(hydroxymethyl)pyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 7.1) and (1H-pyrazol-3-yl)boronic acid to afford a white solid. UPLC-MS (Condition 1)
t
R = 1.89 min, m/z = 448.0 [M+H]
+, m/z = 446.1 [M-H]
-;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.48 - 1.64 (m, 1 H) 1.77 - 1.90 (m, 1 H) 2.15 - 2.28 (m, 1 H) 3.03 (dd, J
= 11.25, 6.85 Hz, 1 H) 3.22 (br. s, 2 H) 3.25 - 3.31 (m, 2 H) 3.34 - 3.39 (m, 1 H)
4.62 (br. s, 1 H) 6.39 (br. s, 1 H) 7.34 (d, J = 8.56 Hz, 2 H) 7.51 - 7.84 (m, 1 H)
7.83 - 7.90 (m, 2 H) 8.03 (s, 1 H) 8.68 - 8.79 (m, 1 H) 10.19 (s, 1 H) 12.87 - 13.12
(m, 1 H).
Stage 7.1: (S)-5-Bromo-6-(3-(hydroxymethyl)pyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0319]

[0320] A mixture of 5-bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
(Stage 2.3, 500 mg, 1.264 mmol), (S)-beta-prolinol hydrochloride (226 mg, 1.643 mmol), DIPEA
(662 µL, 3.79 mmol) and iPrOH (1.945 mL) in a sealed vial was subjected to MW irradiation
at 140°C for 60 min. The solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure and the
residue was treated with aq. 0.5 M HCl (20 mL) and extracted with EtOAc. The combined
extracts were washed with 0.5 M HCl (10 ml) and water, dried over MgSO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give the product which
was triturated with cyclohexane, filtered and dried to afford the title compound as
a white solid. UPLC-MS (Condition 1) t
R = 2.76 min, m/z = 460.0/462.0 [M+H]
+, m/z = 458.0/460.0 [M-H]
-;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.59 - 1.76 (m, 1 H) 1.92 - 2.04 (m, 1 H) 2.26 - 2.44 (m, 1 H) 3.37 - 3.50
(m, 2 H) 3.56 (dd, J = 11.00, 7.34 Hz, 1 H) 3.67 - 3.85 (m, 3 H) 4.71 (br. s, 1 H)
7.35 (d, J = 8.56 Hz, 2 H) 7.85 (d, 1 H) 8.34 (d, J = 1.96 Hz, 1 H) 8.68 (d, J = 1.96
Hz, 1 H) 10.21 (s, 1 H).
Example 8
(S)-N-(4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0321]

[0322] K
3PO
4 (41.3 mg, 0.195 mmol) was added to a solution of (S)-5-bromo-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 8.1, 30 mg, 0.067 mmol) and 1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole
(36.2 mg, 0.13 mmol) in toluene (0.32 mL) in a vial which was flushed with argon.
Pd(PPh
3)
4 (3.75 mg, 0.032 mmol) was added. The vial was sealed and heated at 110°C for 18 h.
After cooling at RT, the RM was dissolved in EtOAc, washed with brine, dried over
Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a crude product
was purified by flash chromatography (RediSep® Silica gel column, DCM / MeOH from
2% to 5% MeOH) to afford N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-((S)-3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide,
a portion of which (21 mg, 0.039 mmol) was dissolved in DCM (0.5 mL), treated with
TFA (0.141 mL, 1.82 mmol) and stirred at RT for 3 h. The RM was poured into 10% aq.
Na
2CO
3 (10 mL) and extracted with EtOAc. The combined extracts were dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give the crude product
which was purified by flash chromatography (RediSep® Silica gel column, DCM / MeOH
from 2% to 5% MeOH) to afford the title compound. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 4.49 min, HPLC Chiral (CHIRALCEL® OD-H, 250 x 4.6 mm, eluent: n-heptane/EtOH/MeOH
(85:10:5), 1 mL/min, UV DAD, t
R = 13.32 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.92 min, m/z = 450.3 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.65 - 1.76 (m, 1 H) 1.77 - 1.92 (m, 1 H) 2.86 - 2.97 (m, 1 H) 3.18 - 3.35
(m, 2 H) 3.34 - 3.47 (m, 1 H) 4.10 - 4.24 (m, 1 H) 4.66 - 4.93 (m, 1 H) 6.28 - 6.42
(m, 1 H) 7.31 (d, J = 8.99 Hz, 2 H) 7.85 (d, J = 8.99 Hz, 3 H) 7.96 - 8.05 (m, 1 H)
8.64 - 8.81 (m, 1 H) 10.17 (s, 1 H) 12.80 - 13.14 (m, 1 H).
Stage 8.1: (S)-5-Bromo-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
[0323]

[0324] DIPEA (190 µL, 1.1 mmol) was added to a solution of 5-bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 9.3, 206 mg, 0.5 mmol) and (S)-pyrrolidin-3-ol (52.3 mg, 0.6 mmol) in iPrOH (500 µL) in
a vial, which was sealed and heated at 140°C for 1 h. After cooling at RT, the RM
was dissolved in EtOAc, washed with 0.5 M aq. HCl and brine, dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give the crude product
which was purified by flash chromatography (RediSep® Silica gel column, n-heptane
/ EtOAc from 20 to 100% EtOAc) to afford the title compound as a white crystalline
powder. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 5.59 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.17 min, m/z = 462.0/464.1 [M+H]
+.
Example 9
(R)-N-(4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0325]

[0326] A mixture of (R)-5-Bromo-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 9.2, 100 mg, 0.216 mmol) and 5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1-((2-(trimethylsilyl)ethoxy)methyl)-1H-pyrazole
(215 mg, 0.663 mmol), Pd(PPh
3)
2Cl
2 (17 mg, 0.024 mmol), Na
2CO
3 (115 mg, 1.081 mmol), DME (917 µL), water (262 µL) and EtOH (131 µL) in a MW vial
was sealed, evacuated / purged 3 times with argon and subjected to MW irradiation
at 125°C for 20 min. The RM was diluted with 2 mL of DME, stirred with Si-Thiol (Silicycle
1.44 mmol/g, 90 mg, 0.130 mmol) for 3 h. The mixture was centrifuged and the supernatant
was filtered through a 0.45 µm PTFE filter and the solvent was evaporated off under
reduced pressure. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography (RediSep®
Silica gel column, 12 g, cyclohexane / EtOAc from 40% to 100% EtOAc) to afford the
protected intermediate as a colorless oil. Ethylene diamine (96 µL, 1.428 mmol) and
TBAF 1 M in THF (1.428 mL, 1.428 mmol) were then added and the RM was stirred at 80-85°C
for 5 days. The solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure and the residue
was dissolved in EtOAc (40 mL), washed 3 times with sat. aq. NaHCO
3 and brine, dried over Na
2SO
4 and The solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a residue which
was purified by preparative SFC (Column DEAP, from 25% to 30% in 6 min) to yield the
title compound as a white solid.
[0327] Alternatively,
Example 9 was prepared by adding TFA (168 mL, 2182 mmol) to a solution of N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-((R)-3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 9.1, 31.3 g, 54.6 mmol) in DCM (600 mL). The mixture was stirred at RT for 2.5 h. The
solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure and the residue was dissolved in
EtOAc (1.5 L),washed with a sat. solution of NaHCO
3 (3 x 500 mL) and brine (500 mL), dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a residue which
was suspended in DCM (300 mL), stirred at RT for 15 min, filtered, washed with DCM
(200 mL), dried and purified by chromatography (Silica gel, 1 kg, DCM / MeOH 95:5).
The residue was dissolved in MeOH (500 mL) and treated with Si-Thiol (Biotage, 5.0
g , 6.5 mmol) for 16 h at 25°C. The resin was filtered off, the solvent was evaporated
off under reduced pressure and the residue was crystallized from MeCN to afford the
title compound as a white crystalline solid.
[0328] Alternatively,
Example 9 was prepared by the dropwise addition of aqueous HCl (7.7 mL of 6M) to a solution
of N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-((R)-3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 9.1, 3.8 g, 7.12 mmol) in MeOH (20 mL) and THF (10 mL) with cooling (below 35°C). The
mixture was stirred at 22°C for 2 h and then added to cooled (10°C) 1.2 M NaOH (22
mL). Throughout the addition the temperature was kept below 30°C and pH was kept in
the range of 9-10. The RM was then stirred for 30 min at 30°C. The solvent was evaporated
off under reduced pressure, until the desired compound precipitated. The precipitate
was filtered and dried to give the title compound as a yellow solid.
[0329] Analytical data for
Example 9: HPLC (Condition 5) t
R = 5.54 min, HPLC Chiral (CHIRALCEL® OD-H, 250 x 4.6 mm, eluent: n-heptane/EtOH/MeOH
(85:10:5), 1 mL/min, UV 210 nm) t
R = 10.17 min, UPLC-MS (condition 3) t
R = 0.93 min, m/z = 450.3 [M+H]
+, m/z = 494.1 [M+formic acid-H]
-;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.65 - 1.76 (m, 1 H) 1.76 - 1.87 (m, 1 H) 2.93 (d, J=11.73 Hz, 1 H) 3.19 -
3.29 (m, 2 H) 3.35 - 3.51 (m, 1 H) 4.10 - 4.25 (m, 1 H) 4.89 (br. s, 1 H) 6.41 (br.
s, 1 H) 7.33 (d, J=8.50 Hz, 2 H) 7.57/7.83 (br. s, 1 H) 7.90 (d, J=8.50 Hz, 2 H) 8.07
(br. s, 1 H) 8.77 (br. s, 1 H) 10.23 (s, 1 H) 12.97/13.15 (br. s, 1 H).
Stage 9.1: N-(4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-((R)-3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0330]

[0331] 1-(Tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole
(29.6 g, 102 mmol), K
3PO
4 (51.6 g, 236 mmol) and Pd(PPh
3)
4 (4.55 g, 3.93 mmol) were added to a suspension of (R)-5-bromo-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 9.2, 36.4 g, 79 mmol) in toluene (360 mL) under an argon atmosphere and the mixture was
stirred at 110°C for 4 h. The RM was poured into brine (500 mL) and extracted with
EtOAc (2 x 1 L). The combined extracts were washed with brine (500 mL), dried over
Na
2SO
4, and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a residue which
was purified by chromatography (Silica gel column, 1.5 kg, DCM / MeOH 95:5) to afford
a dark yellow foam, that was dissolved in MeOH / DCM (1 L of 3:1) and treated with
Si-Thiol (Biotage, 35 g , 45.5 mmol) for 17 h at 30°C. The resin was filtered off,
and solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure, until the desired compound
crystallized. The product was filtered washed with MeOH and dried to afford the title
compound.
[0332] Alternatively,
Stage 9.1 was prepared by adding 4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)aniline (16.6 g, 84.9 mmol), NMM
(21.7 g, 212.1 mmol), hydroxybenzotriazole hydrate (HOBt·H
2O, 11.9 g, 77.77 mmol) and 1-ethyl-3-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)carbodiimide hydrochloride
(EDCI·HCl, 20.9 g, 109.0 mmol) to a solution of 6-((R)-3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinic
acid (
Stage 9.4, 29.83 g, 70.7 mmol) in THF (271 mL). The mixture was stirred for 1.5 h at 25°C and
then at 65°C for 16 h. After cooling the RM to 35 °C, further EDCI·HCl (13.3 g, 69.4
mmol) was added and the RM was stirred for 1.5 h at 35°C then again at 65°C for 16
h. After cooling the RM to 35°C, water (150 mL) was added, the THF was removed under
reduced pressure, EtOAc (180 mL) was added and the mixture was stirred for at 35 °C
for 1 h. The two layers were separated and the aq. phase was then extracted with EtOAc
(60 mL). The combined organic layers were washed with water (90 mL), brine (90 mL).
The solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a brown solid which
was purified by column chromatography (Silica gel, DCM / MeOH 40:1 to 20:1) to afford
the title compound as a yellow solid.
[0333] Analytical data for
Stage 9.1: HPLC (Condition 5) t
R = 6.12 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.06 min, m/z = 533.2 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.36 - 2.02 (m, 7 H) 2.23 - 2.38 (m, 1 H) 3.08 - 3.29 (m, 2 H) 3.32 - 3.52
(m, 2 H) 3.73 - 3.93 (m, 1 H) 4.13 - 4.25 (m, 1 H) 4.80 - 4.90 (m, 1 H) 4.95 - 5.17
(m, 1 H) 6.33 - 6.50 (m, 1 H) 7.33 (d, J=8.99 Hz, 2 H) 7.61 (d, J=1.56 Hz, 1 H) 7.86
(d, J=8.99 Hz, 2 H) 7.97 - 8.11 (m, 1 H) 8.82 (s, 1 H) 10.13 - 10.25 (m, 1 H).
Stage 9.2: (R)-5-Bromo-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
[0334]

[0335] (R)-Pyrrolidin-3-ol (9.55 g, 109.6 mmol) and DIPEA (35.1 ml, 201.3 mmol) were added
to a suspension of 5-bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 9.3, 37.7 g, 91.5 mmol) in iPrOH (65 mL) and stirred at 140°C for 1 h. EtOAc (700 mL)
was added and the solution was washed IN HCl (2 x 200 mL), sat. NaHCO
3 (200 mL) and brine (2 x 200 mL), dried over Na
2SO
4, and the solution was concentrated under reduced pressure until crystallization commenced.
n-Heptane (1 L) were added and the mixture was stirred at RT for 30 min, filtered
and washed with iPr
2O (500 mL) to afford the title compound as a white crystalline solid. HPLC (Condition
5) t
R = 6.68 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.10 min, m/z = 462.2/464.2 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.78 - 2.01 (m, 2 H) 3.55 (d, J=11.34 Hz, 1 H) 3.66 - 3.75 (m, 1 H) 3.79 -
3.93 (m, 2 H) 4.34 (br. s, 1 H) 4.98 (d, =3.13 Hz, 1 H) 7.32 (d, J=8.99 Hz, 2 H) 7.84
(d, J=8.99 Hz, 2 H) 8.33 (d, J=1.96 Hz, 1 H) 8.66 (d, J=1.96 Hz, 1 H) 10.21 (s, 1
H).
Stage 9.3: 5-Bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0336]

[0337] DMF (2.55 mL, 33.0 mmol) and SOCl
2 (24.08 ml, 330 mmol) were added to a suspension of 5-bromo-6-chloro-nicotinic acid
(26 g, 110 mmol) in toluene (220 mL) and the RM was stirred at 80°C for 1 h. The solvent
was evaporated off under reduced pressure and the residue was dissolved in THF (220
mL) and cooled to -16°C. DIPEA (38.4 mL, 220 mmol) was added, followed by dropwise
addition of a solution of 4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)aniline (22.35 g, 115 mmol) in
THF (220 mL) over 15 min. The suspension was stirred for 1 h at RT. The solvent was
evaporated off under reduced pressure and the residue was dissolved in TBME (700 mL),
washed with IN HCl (2 x 200 mL), sat. NaHCO
3 (200 mL) and brine (2 x 200 mL), dried over Na
2SO
4, and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give the product which
was crystallized from EtOAc - n-heptane to afford the title compound as a white crystalline
solid. HPLC (Condition 5) t
R = 7.77 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.24 min, m/z = 409.1/411.1/413.1 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 7.38 (d, =8.99 Hz, 2 H) 7.85 (d, =8.99 Hz, 2 H) 8.72 (br. s, 1 H) 8.92 (br.
s, 1 H) 10.68 (s, 1 H).
Stage 9.4: 6-((R)-3-Hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinic
acid
[0338]

[0339] Aq. NaOH (180 mL of 2.6 M) was added to a solution of methyl 6-((R)-3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinate
(
Stage 9.5, 111g, 299 mmol) in MeOH (270 mL) and the RM was stirred at RT for 14 h. The MeOH
was evaporated off under reduced pressure and the aq. residue was treated with brine
(90 mL), extracted with MeTHF twice (540 mL + 360 mL) and the combined organic layers
were washed with water (90 mL). MeTHF was added to the combined aq. layers, the biphasic
mixture was cooled to 0 °C and acidified (pH = 4-4.5) with aq. HCl solution (18%)
and extracted with MeTHF. The combined organic extracts were washed with brine and
the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a residue which was
recrystallized from a EtOAc / TBME (1:1) to afford the title compound as a white solid.
HPLC (Condition 7) t
R = 4.74 min, LC-MS (Condition 8) t
R = 3.37 min, m/z = 359.0 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.44 (br. s, 2 H), 1.51 (d, J=11.54 Hz, 2 H), 1.64 - 1.86 (m, 4 H), 1.90 (br.
s, 1 H), 2.31 (d, J=9.29 Hz, 1 H), 2.77 (br. s, 1 H), 3.10 (br. s, 1 H), 3.21 (d,
J=8.78 Hz, 2 H), 3.27 - 3.51 (m, 4 H), 3.87 (d, J=11.54 Hz, 1 H), 4.16 (br. s, 1 H),
4.75 - 4.93 (m, 1 H), 5.04 (br. s, 1 H), 6.35 (d, J=17.32 Hz, 1 H), 7.51 - 7.64 (m,
1 H), 7.64 - 7.82 (m, 1 H), 8.67 (d, J=2.26 Hz, 1 H), 12.58 (br. s, 1 H).
Stage 9.5: Methyl 6-((R)-3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinate
[0340]

[0341] A mixture of (R)-methyl 5-bromo-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinate (
Stage 9.6, 90 g, 299 mmol), 1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-5-boronic acid pinacol
ester (103.9 g, 373.6 mmol), K
3PO
4 (126.9 g, 597.7 mmol), Pd(PPh
3)
2Cl
2 (6.29 g, 8.97 mmol) in toluene (900 mL) was stirred at 92°C and for 16 h. After cooling
the mixture to RT, the solution was washed with water (450 mL), 5% NaHCO
3 solution (430 mL) and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give
a residue which was used without further purifications in the next step. HPLC (Condition
7) t
R = 6.929 min, LC-MS (Condition 8) t
R = 4.30 min, m/z = 373.0 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.19 - 1.28 (m, 1 H), 1.35 - 1.63 (m, 4 H), 1.63 - 1.86 (m, 3 H), 1.89 (br.
s, 1 H), 2.12 - 2.39 (m, 1 H), 3.11 (br. s, 1 H), 3.18 - 3.48 (m, 4 H), 3.78 (s, 4
H), 3.88 (d, J=11.54 Hz, 1 H), 4.08 - 4.24 (m, 1 H), 4.86 (dd, J=18.20, 2.89 Hz, 1
H), 5.02 (d, J=8.28 Hz, 1 H), 6.39 (br. s, 1 H), 7.58 (d, J=1.25 Hz, 1 H), 7.78 (br.
s, 1 H), 8.69 (t, J=2.01 Hz, 1 H).
Stage 9.6: (R)-methyl 5-bromo-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinate
[0342]

[0343] DIPEA (105.3 g, 142.2 mL, 814.4 mmol) was added to a solution of methyl-5-bromo-6-chroronicotinate
(85 g, 339.5 mmol) and (R)-pyrrolidin-3-ol (54.2 g, 441.2 mmol) in isopropyl acetate
and the RM was stirred at 70°C for 14 h . The solvent was evaporated off under reduced
pressure to give a the residue which was dissolved in toluene (850 mL), washed with
water (127 mL) and brine (127 mL)and concentrated under reduced pressure until precipitation
commenced. n-Heptane (340 mL) was slowly added to the stirred mixture at 22 °C, which
was then cooled to 0 °C and the product was filtered, washed with a toluene / n-heptane
mixture (1:1.5) and dried to give the title compound as a yellow solid. HPLC (Condition
7) t
R = 8.54 min, LC-MS (Condition 8) t
R = 4.62 min, m/z = 300.9/302.9 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.77 - 1.99 (m, 2 H), 3.57 (d, J=11.54 Hz, 1 H), 3.72 (ddd, J=11.11, 7.97,
3.26 Hz, 1 H), 3.78 (s, 3 H), 3.81 -3.90 (m, 2 H), 4.26 - 4.39 (m, 1 H), 4.99 (br.
s, 1 H), 8.11 (d, J=2.01 Hz, 1 H), 8.56 (d, J=1.76 Hz, 1 H).
Example 10
(S)-N-(4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-(hydroxymethyl)pyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0344]

[0345] A mixture of (S)-5-bromo-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-(hydroxymethyl)pyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
(Stage 10.1, 119 mg, 0.25 mmol), 1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole
(139 mg, 0.5 mmol), Pd(PPh
3)
2Cl
2 (0.018 g, 0.025 mmol), Na
2CO
3 (0.106 g, 1.000 mmol), DME (1.061 mL), water (0.303 mL) and EtOH (0.152 mL) were
added to a MW vial which was sealed, evacuated / purged 3 times with argon then subjected
to MW irradiation at 125°C for 20 min. The RM was diluted with DME (2 mL) and stirred
overnight with Si-Thiol (Silicycle 1.43 mmol/g, 0.105 g, 0.150 mmol). The mixture
was centrifuged and the supernatant was filtered through a 0.45 µm PTFE filter and
the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure. The crude product was purified
by flash chromatography (RediSep® Silica gel column, 12 g, cyclohexane / EtOAc from
20% to 90% EtOAc) to afford the protected intermediate which was treated with a mixture
of DCM (2.5 mL) and TFA (0.963 mL, 12.50 mmol) and stirred at RT for 2 h. The solvent
was evaporated off under reduced pressure and the residue treated with a solution
of 7 N NH
3 in MeOH (2 mL, 14 mmol). The solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure and
the residue was purified by preparative SFC (Column DEAP, isocratic 28% in 9 min)
to afford the title compound as a yellow oil. UPLC-MS (Condition 1) t
R =1.87 min, m/z = 464.1 [M+H]
+, m/z = 462.1 [M-H]
-;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.49 - 1.65 (m, 1 H) 1.75 - 1.97 (m, 1 H) 2.14 - 2.30 (m, 1 H) 3.04 (dd, J
= 11.37, 6.97 Hz, 1 H) 3.14 - 3.26 (m, 2 H) 3.26 - 3.29 (m, 1 H) 3.35 - 3.46 (m, 2
H) 4.60 (t, J = 5.14 Hz, 1 H) 6.39 (d, J = 1.96 Hz, 1 H) 7.33 (d, J = 9.05 Hz, 2 H)
7.76 (br. s, 1 H) 7.84 - 7.94 (m, 2 H) 8.04 (d, J = 2.45 Hz, 1 H) 8.74 (s, 1 H) 10.18
(s, 1 H) 12.87 (br. s, 1 H).
Stage 10.1: (S)-5-Bromo-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-(hydroxymethyl)pyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
[0346]

[0347] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Stage 9.2 using 5-bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
(Stage 9.3) and (S)-1-pyrrolidin-3-yl-methanol to afford an off-white crystalline solid. HPLC
(Condition 4) t
R = 5.82 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.14 min, m/z = 476.2/478.3 [M+H]
+.
Example 11
(R)-6-(3-Hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)-N-(4-((trifluoromethyl)thio)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0348]

[0349] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Example 9 using (R)-5-bromo-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-((trifluoromethyl)thio)phenyl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 11.1) and 5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1-((2-(trimethylsilyl)ethoxy)methyl)-1H-pyrazole
to afford a white solid. UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.97 min, m/z = 450.2 [M+H]
+, m/z = 448.1 [M-H]
-;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.67 - 1.78 (m, 1 H) 1.78 - 1.88 (m, 1 H) 2.94 (d, J = 11.92 Hz, 1 H) 3.19
- 3.34 (m, 2 H) 3.38 - 3.50 (m, 1 H) 4.20 (br. s, 1 H) 4.81 - 4.93 (m, 1 H) 6.33 -
6.45 (m, 1 H) 7.83 (m, J = 113.40, 8.20 Hz, 3 H) 7.93 (d, J = 8.66 Hz, 2 H) 7.99 -
8.08 (m, 1 H) 8.70 - 8.81 (m, 1 H) 10.30 (s, 1 H) 12.90 - 13.16 (m, 1 H).
Stage 11.1: (R)-5-Bromo-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-((trifluoromethyl)thio)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0350]

[0351] DIPEA (73 µL, 0.42 mmol) was added to a solution of 5-bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-((trifluoromethyl)thio)phenyl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 11.2, 123 mg, 0.3 mmol) and (R)-pyrrolidin-3-ol (31.4 mg, 0.36 mmol) in iPrOH (300 µL)
in a vial, which was sealed and heated at 140°C for 1 h. After cooling at RT, the
RM was diluted with EtOAc, washed with brine, dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a residue which was
triturated with iPr
2O, filtered and dried to afford the title compound as a white crystalline powder.
HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 5.9 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.21 min, m/z = 464.1 [M+H]
+.
Stage 11.2 : 5-Bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-((trifluoromethyl)thio)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0352]

[0353] DMF (0.12 mL) was added followed by slow addition of SOCl
2 (0.73 mL, 10 mmol) to a mixture of 5-bromo-6-chloro-nicotinic acid (473 mg, 2 mmol)
in toluene (5 mL), and the RM was then stirred at 80°C for 1 h. After cooling at RT,
the toluene was evaporated off under reduce pressure and the residue was dissolved
in THF (0.4 mL). DIPEA (0.7 mL, 4 mmol) was added and the solution was cooled to 0°C
under nitrogen. 4-trifluoromethylsulfanyl-aniline (438 mg, 2.2 mmol) in THF (1 mL)
was then added dropwise and the RM was stirred at 0°C for 2 h. The RM was diluted
with TBME (50 mL), treated with 1 M HCl and extracted with TBME. The combined extracts
were washed with 1 M aq. NaOH and brine, dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure and the product was crystallized
from TBME / n-hexane to give the title compound as an off-white crystalline powder.
HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 6.63 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.33 min, m/z = 411.1 [M+H]
+.
Example 12
(S)-6-(3-(Hydroxymethyl)pyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)-N-(4-((trifluoromethyl)thio)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0354]

[0355] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in Example
10 using (S)-5-bromo-6-(3-(hydroxymethyl)pyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-((trifluoromethyl)thio)phenyl)nicotinamide
(Stage 12.1) and 1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole
to afford a pale yellow powder. UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.99 min, m/z = 464.2 [M+H]
+, m/z = 462.2 [M-H]
-;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) d ppm 1.48 - 1.64 (m, 1 H) 1.76 - 1.93 (m, 1 H) 2.15 - 2.27 (m, 1 H) 3.04 (dd, J
= 11.49, 7.09 Hz, 1 H) 3.18 - 3.26 (m, 2 H) 3.27 - 3.29 (m, 1 H) 3.32 - 3.41 (m, 2
H) 4.60 (br. s, 1 H) 6.39 (d, J = 1.71 Hz, 1 H) 7.67 (d, J = 8.56 Hz, 2 H) 7.80 (br.
s, 1 H) 7.87 - 7.99 (m, 2 H) 8.04 (d, J = 2.45 Hz, 1 H) 8.74 (br. s, 1 H) 10.28 (s,
1 H) 12.76 - 13.20 (m, 1 H).
Stage 12.1: (S)-5-Bromo-6-(3-(hydroxymethyl)pyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-((trifluoromethyl)thio)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0356]

[0357] DIPEA (4.89 mL, 28.0 mmol) was added to a solution of 5-bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-((trifluoromethyl)thio)phenyl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 11.2, 2.88 g, 7.0 mmol) and (S)-1-pyrrolidin-3-yl-methanol (1.156, 8.40 mmol) in iPrOH
(7.0 mL)in a vial, which was sealed and then heated at 140°C for 1 h. After cooling
at RT, the RM was dissolved in EtOAc, washed with aq. 0.5 M HCl and brine, dried over
Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a residue which
was triturated with iPr
2O, filtered and dried to give the title compound as a beige crystalline powder. HPLC
(Condition 4) t
R = 6.17 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.20 min, m/z = 476.2/478.2 [M+H]
+.
Example 13
(R)-N-(3-Fluoro-4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0358]

[0359] A mixture of (R)-N-(3-fluoro-4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1-((2-(trimethylsilyl)ethoxy)methyl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 13.1, 64 mg, 0.11 mmol), ethylene diamine (37.2 µL, 0.55 mmol) and 1 M TBAF in THF (1.651
mL, 1.651 mmol) in a MW vial was sealed and stirred at 80-85°C for 20 h. The solvent
was evaporated off under reduced pressure and the residue was dissolved in EtOAc (40
mL), washed 3 times with sat. aq. NaHCO
3 and brine, dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a crude product
which was purified by preparative SFC (Column Diol, isocratic 27%) to yield the title
compound as a white solid. UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.95 min, m/z = 452.3 [M+H]
+, m/z = 450.3 [M-H]
-;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.64 - 1.78 (m, 1 H) 1.78 - 1.89 (m, 1 H) 2.95 (d, J = 11.74 Hz, 1 H) 3.29
(br. s, 2 H) 3.37 - 3.49 (m, 1 H) 4.20 (br. s, 1 H) 4.83 (br. s, 1 H) 6.35 - 6.42
(m, 1 H) 7.52 (t, J = 9.05 Hz, 1 H) 7.62 (d, J = 9.29 Hz, 1 H) 7.74 (br. s, 1 H) 7.98
(dd, J = 13.20, 2.20 Hz, 1 H) 8.02 (d, J = 2.20 Hz, 1 H) 8.74 (d, J = 1.71 Hz, 1 H)
10.31 (br. s, 1 H) 12.95 (br. s, 1 H).
Stage 13.1: (R)-N-(3-Fluoro-4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1-((2-(trimethylsilyl)ethoxy)methyl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0360]

[0361] A mixture of (R)-5-bromo-N-(3-fluoro-4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 13.2, 100 mg, 0.215 mmol), 5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1-((2-(trimethylsilyl)ethoxy)methyl)-1H-pyrazole
(104 mg, 0.321 mmol), Pd(PPh
3)
2Cl
2 (15.2 mg, 0.022 mmol), Na
2CO
3 (91 mg, 0.862 mmol), DME (914 µL), water (261 µL) and EtOH (131 µL) in a MW vial
was sealed, evacuated / purged 3 times with argon and subjected to MW irradiation
at 125°C for 20 min. The RM was diluted with DME (3 mL), then stirred overnight with
Si-Thiol (Silicycle 1.44 mmol/g, 90 mg, 0.129 mmol). The mixture was centrifuged and
the supernatant was filtered through a 0.45 µm PTFE filter and the solvent was evaporated
off under reduced pressure to give a residue which was purified by preparative SFC
(Column DEAP, from 15% to 20% in 6 min) to yield the title compound as a yellow transparent
oil. UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.28 min, m/z = 581.2 [M+H]
+, m/z = 580.4 [M-H]
-.
Stage 13.2 : (R)-5-Bromo-N-(3-fluoro-4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
[0362]

[0363] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in Stage
9.2 using 5-bromo-6-chloro-N-(3-fluoro-4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide (
Stage 13.3) and (R)-pyrrolidin-3-ol to afford an off-white crystalline solid. HPLC (Condition
4) t
R = 5.82 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.17 min, m/z = 464.1 [M+H]
+.
Stage 13.3: 5-Bromo-6-chloro-N-(3-fluoro-4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0364]

[0365] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in Stage
11.2 using 5-bromo-6-chloro-nicotinic acid and 3-fluoro-4-trifluoromethoxy-aniline
to afford an off-white crystalline solid. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 6.43 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.29 min, m/z = 413 [M-H]
-.
Example 14
(S)-N-(3-Fluoro-4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-(hydroxymethyl)pyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0366]

[0367] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Example 10 using (S)-5-bromo-N-(3-fluoro-4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-(hydroxymethyl)pyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
(Stage 14.1) and 1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole
to afford a pale yellow powder. UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.96 min, m/z = 466.2 [M+H]
+, m/z = 464.2 [M-H]
-.
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) d ppm 2.77 (s, 3 H) 3.38 - 3.61 (m, 4 H) 4.61 (br. s, 1 H) 6.47 (s, 1 H) 7.68 (d,
J = 8.56 Hz, 2 H) 7.83 (br. s, 1 H) 7.93 (d, J = 8.80 Hz, 2 H) 8.15 (br. s, 1 H) 8.71
(br. s, 1 H) 10.36 (s, 1 H) 12.83 - 13.15 (m, 1 H).
Stage 14.1: (S)-5-Bromo-N-(3-fluoro-4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-(hydroxymethyl)pyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
[0368]

[0369] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Stage 9.2 using 5-bromo-6-chloro-N-(3-fluoro-4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide (
Stage 13.3) and (S)-1-pyrrolidin-3-yl-methanol to afford an off-white crystalline solid. HPLC
(Condition 4) t
R = 5.99 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.18 min, m/z = 478.1/480.1 [M+H]
+.
Example 15
(R)-N-(3-Fluoro-4-((trifluoromethyl)thio)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0370]

[0371] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Example 13 using (R)-N-(3-fluoro-4-((trifluoromethyl)thio)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1-((2-(trimethylsilyl)ethoxy)methyl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 15.1) to afford an off-white solid. UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.00 min, m/z = 468.3 [M+H]
+, m/z = 466.1 [M-H]
-;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.68 - 1.78 (m, 1 H) 1.79 - 1.89 (m, 1 H) 2.96 (d, J = 11.74 Hz, 1 H) 3.24
- 3.30 (m, 2 H) 3.40 - 3.49 (m, 1 H) 4.20 (d, J = 2.20 Hz, 1 H) 4.84 (br. s, 1 H)
6.38 (d, J = 1.96 Hz, 1 H) 7.66 - 7.78 (m, 3 H) 7.98 (dd, J = 11.98, 1.96 Hz, 1 H)
8.03 (d, J = 2.45 Hz, 1 H) 8.75 (d, J = 2.45 Hz, 1 H) 10.24 - 10.72 (m, 1 H) 12.59
- 13.22 (m, 1 H).
Stage 15.1: (R)-N-(3-Fluoro-4-((trifluoromethyl)thio)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1-((2-(trimethylsilyl)ethoxy)methyl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0372]

[0373] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Stage 13.1 using (R)-5-bromo-N-(3-fluoro-4-((trifluoromethyl)thio)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 15.2) and 5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1-((2-(trimethylsilyl)ethoxy)methyl)-1H-pyrazole
to afford a yellow resin. UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.33 min, m/z = 598.4 [M+H]
+, m/z = 596.5 [M-H]
-.
Stage 15.2: (R)-5-Bromo-N-(3-fluoro-4-((trifluoromethyl)thio)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
[0374]

[0375] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Stage 9.2 using 5-bromo-6-chloro-N-(3-fluoro-4-((trifluoromethyl)thio)phenyl)nicotinamide (
Stage 15.3) and (R)-pyrrolidin-3-ol to afford an off-white crystalline solid. HPLC (Condition
4) t
R = 6.11 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.23 min, m/z = 480.1 [M+H]
+.
Stage 15.3: 5-Bromo-6-chloro-N-(3-fluoro-4-((trifluoromethyl)thio)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0376]

[0377] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Stage 11.2 using 5-bromo-6-chloro-nicotinic acid and 3-fluoro-4-trifluoromethylsulfanyl-aniline
to afford a white crystalline solid. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 6.71 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.34 min, m/z = 429 [M-H]
-.
Example 16
(R)-6-(3-Hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(perfluoroethyl)phenyl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0378]

[0379] A mixture of (R)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(perfluoroethyl)phenyl)-5-(1-((2-(trimethylsilyl)ethoxy)methyl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 16.1, 68 mg, 0.114 mmol) and ethylene damien (38.4 µL, 0.569 mmol) in a MW vial and sealed
under an argon atmosphere 1 M TBAF in THF (1.707 mL, 1.707 mmol) was added and the
RM was stirred at 80°C for 20 h. The solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure
and the residue was dissolved in EtOAc (40 mL), washed 3 times with sat. aq. NaHCO
3 and brine, dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a residue which
was purified by preparative SFC (Column Diol, isocratic 27% in 9 min) to afford the
title compound as an off-white solid. UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.98 min, m/z = 468.2 [M+H]
+, m/z = 466.2 [M-H]
-;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.68 - 1.78 (m, 1 H) 1.83 (dd, J = 8.80, 4.40 Hz, 1 H) 2.96 (d, J = 11.74
Hz, 1 H) 3.19 - 3.29 (m, 2 H) 3.40 - 3.50 (m, 1 H) 4.20 (br. s, 1 H) 4.83 (br. s,
1 H) 6.39 (d, J = 1.96 Hz, 1 H) 7.65 (d, J = 8.80 Hz, 2 H) 7.77 (br. s, 1 H) 8.02
(d, J = 9.05 Hz, 2 H) 8.05 (d, J = 2.45 Hz, 1 H) 8.76 (d, J = 2.20 Hz, 1 H) 10.33
(s, 1 H) 12.91 (br. s, 1 H).
Stage 16.1: (R)-6-(3-Hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(perfluoroethyl)phenyl)-5-(1-((2-(trimethylsilyl)ethoxy)methyl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0380]

[0381] A mixture of (R)-5-bromo-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(perfluoroethyl)phenyl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 16.2, 100 mg, 0.208 mmol), 5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1-((2-(trimethylsilyl)ethoxy)methyl)-1H-pyrazole
(135 mg, 0.416 mmol), Pd(PPh
3)
2Cl
2 (14.62 mg, 0.021 mmol), Na
2CO
3 (88 mg, 0.833 mmol), DME (883 µL), water (252 µL) and EtOH (126 µL) in a MW vial,
which was sealed, evacuated / purged 3 times with argon and subjected to MW irradiation
at 125°C for 20 min. The RM was diluted with 3 mL of DME, then stirred overnight with
Si-Thiol (Silicycle 1.44 mmol/g, 87 mg, 0.125 mmol) overnight. The mixture was centrifuged
and the supernatant was filtered through a 0.45 µm PTFE filter and the solvent was
evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a residue which was purified by preparative
SFC (Column Diol, from 15% to 20% in 6 min) to yield the title compound as a colorless
transparent resin. UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.31 min, m/z = 598.4 [M+H]
+, m/z = 596.3 [M-H]
-.
Stage 16.2 : (R)-5-Bromo-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(perfluoroethyl)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0382]

[0383] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Stage 9.2 using 5-bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-(perfluoroethyl)phenyl)nicotinamide (
Stage 16.3) and (R)-pyrrolidin-3-ol to afford an off-white crystalline solid. HPLC (Condition
4) t
R = 5.96 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.20 min, m/z = 480.2 [M+H]
+.
Stage 16.3: 5-Bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-(perfluoroethyl)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0384]

[0385] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Stage 11.2 using 5-bromo-6-chloro-nicotinic acid and 4-pentafluoroethyl-aniline to afford a
white crystalline solid. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 6.61 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.32 min, m/z = 429 [M-H]
-.
Example 17
(R)-6-(3-Hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(pentafluorosulfanyl)phenyl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0386]

[0387] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Example 8 using (R)-5-bromo-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(pentafluorosulfanyl)phenyl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 17.1) and 1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole
to afford a beige solid. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 4.68 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.92 min, m/z = 476.3 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.64 - 1.91 (m, 2 H) 2.93 (d, J = 11.73 Hz, 1 H) 3.19 - 3.34 (m, 2 H) 3.36
- 3.49 (m, 1 H) 4.12 - 4.24 (m, 1 H) 4.81 (d, J = 3.13 Hz, 1 H) 6.38 (s, 1 H) 7.73
- 7.89 (m, 3 H) 7.92 - 8.09 (m, 3 H) 8.73 (d, J = 1.96 Hz, 1 H) 10.37 (s, 1 H) 12.82
- 13.17 (m, 1 H).
Stage 17.1: (R)-5-Bromo-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(pentafluorosulfanyl)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0388]

[0389] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Stage 9.2 using 5-bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-(pentafluorosulfanyl)phenyl)nicotinamide (
Stage 17.2) and (R)-pyrrolidin-3-ol to afford a solid. UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.16 min, m/z = 490.1 [M+H]
+.
Stage 17.2: 5-Bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-(pentafluorosulfanyl)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0390]

[0391] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Stage 11.2 using 5-bromo-6-chloro-nicotinic acid and 4-aminophenylsulfur pentafluoride to afford
an orange solid. HPLC (Condition 4), t
R = 6.43 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3), t
R = 1.27 min, m/z = 435.3/437.2 [M+H]
+.
Example 18
(R)-N-(4-((Chlorodifluoromethyl)thio)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0392]

[0393] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Example 8 using (R)-5-bromo-N-(4-((chlorodifluoromethyl)thio)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 18.1) and 1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole
to afford an off-white solid. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 4.94 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.99 min, m/z = 466.3 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.65 - 1.88 (m, 2 H) 2.86 - 2.99 (m, 1 H) 3.19 - 3.33 (m, 2 H) 3.36 - 3.51
(m, 1 H) 4.13 - 4.23 (m, 1 H) 4.76 - 4.90 (m, 1 H) 6.31 - 6.42 (m, 1 H) 7.65 (d, J
= 8.21 Hz, 2 H) 7.76 - 7.84 (m, 1 H) 7.92 (d, J = 8.60 Hz, 2 H) 7.98 - 8.08 (m, 1
H) 8.66 - 8.82 (m, 1 H) 10.28 (s, 1 H) 12.82 - 13.14 (m, 1 H).
Stage 18.1: (R)-5-Bromo-N-(4-((chlorodifluoromethyl)thio)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
[0394]

[0395] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Stage 9.2 using 5-bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-((chlorodifluoromethyl)thio)phenyl)nicotinamide (Stage
18.2) and (R)-pyrrolidin-3-ol to afford an off-white crystalline solid. HPLC (Condition
4) t
R = 5.97 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.19 min, m/z = 478.2/480.1 [M+H]
+.
Stage 18.2 : 5-Bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-((chlorodifluoromethyl)thio)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0396]

[0397] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in Stage
11.2 using 5-bromo-6-chloro-nicotinic acid and 4-((chloro-difluoromethyl)thio)aniline
(
Stage 18.3) to afford an off-white crystalline solid. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 6.78 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.32 min, m/z = 425 [M-H]
-.
Stage 18.3 : 4-((Chlorodifluoromethyl)thio)aniline
[0398]

[0399] To a solution of 4-nitrophenylchlorodifluoromethyl sulfide (prepared as described
in
DE2845997, 627, 67.5 g, 0.28 mol) in ethanol (270 mL) and water (68 mL) stirred at 72 °C was
added concentrated HCl (3.4 mL, 41.5 mmol) and iron powder (203 g, 3.63 mol) in three
portions over 10 min. The RM was stirred at 82 °C for 30 min, filtered through Celite®
(EtOH), the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a yellow oil
which was dissolved in DCM and washed with sat. NaHCO
3 and brine. The organic phase was dried over MgSO4, filtered and the filtrate was
evaporated off under reduced pressure to give the crude product as a yellow oil which
was distilled (b.p. 88-92°C, 0.9 mmHg) and filtered through Celite® to afford the
title compound as a pale yellow oil.
1H-NMR (300 MHz, CDCl
3) δ ppm 3.98 (br. s, 2 H) 6.67 (dd, 2 H) 7.43 (dd, 2 H).
Example 19
(R)-6-(3-Hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(perfluoroethoxy)phenyl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0400]

[0401] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Example 8 using (R)-5-bromo-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(perfluoroethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 19.1) and 1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole
to afford an off-white solid. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 4.86 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.97 min, m/z = 484.4 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.62 - 1.92 (m, 2 H) 2.94 (d, J = 1.00 Hz, 1 H) 3.18 - 3.34 (m, 2 H) 3.37
- 3.51 (m, 1 H) 4.13 - 4.22 (m, 1 H) 4.70 - 4.91 (m, 1 H) 6.37 (br. s, 1 H) 7.31 (d,
J = 8.99 Hz, 2 H) 7.86 (m, J = 9.00 Hz, 3 H) 8.01 (br. s, 1 H) 8.65 - 8.83 (m, 1 H)
10.17 (s, 1 H) 12.84 - 13.11 (m, 1 H).
Stage 19.1: (R)-5-Bromo-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(perfluoroethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0402]

[0403] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Stage 9.2 using 5-bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-(perfluoroethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide (
Stage 19.2) and (R)-pyrrolidin-3-ol to afford an off-white crystalline solid. HPLC (Condition
4) t
R = 6.01 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.17 min, m/z = 496.2 [M+H]
+.
Stage 19.2: 5-Bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-(perfluoroethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0404]

[0405] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Stage 9.3 using 5-bromo-6-chloro-nicotinic acid and 4-(perfluoroethoxy)aniline to afford an
off-white crystalline solid. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 6.73 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.30 min, m/z = 443.1 [M-H]
-.
Example 20
(R)-N-(4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-4-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-3-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)benzamide
[0406]

[0407] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Example 8 using (R)-3-bromo-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-4-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)benzamide
(
Stage 20.1) and 1-(Tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-5-boronic acid pinacol ester to afford
an off-white solid. UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.99 min, m/z = 449.0 [M+H]
+, m/z = 493.0 [M+formic acid-H]
-; 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.67 - 1.79 (m, 1 H) 1.80 - 1.92 (m, 1 H) 2.72 (d, J=10.88 Hz, 1 H) 3.03 -
3.18 (m, 2 H) 3.19 - 3.30 (m, 1 H) 4.19 (br. s, 1 H) 4.77 - 4.92 (m, 1 H) 6.22 - 6.42
(m, 1 H) 6.76 - 6.93 (m, 1 H) 7.31 (d, J=8.56 Hz, 2 H) 7.45 - 7.81 (m, 1 H) 7.83 -
7.95 (m, 4 H) 10.12 (s, 1 H) 12.71 - 13.12 (m, 1 H).
Stage 20.1: (R)-3-Bromo-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-4-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)benzamide
[0408]

[0409] A mixture of 3-bromo-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-4-fluorobenzamide (1 g,
2.53 mmol), (R)-pyrrolidin-3-ol (0.331 g, 3.80 mmol), TEA (0.706 mL, 5.07 mmol) and
DMSO (2.53 mL) was stirred at 90°C for 20 h. The RM was treated with 0.5 M HCl (50
mL) and extracted with EtOAc. The combined extracts were washed with 0.5 M HCl, sat.
aq. NaHCO
3 and brine, dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give the crude product
which was purified by flash chromatography (RediSep® Silica gel column, 40 g, cyclohexane
/ EtOAc, from 1% to 4.5% EtOAc). The fractions containing the pure product were combined
and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a residue which
was triturated under cyclohexane to yield the title product as a white amorphous solid.
UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.15 min, m/z = 462.9 [M+H]
+, m/z = 460.9 [M-H]
-; 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) 0 ppm 1.81 - 1.90 (m, 1 H) 1.92 - 2.03 (m, 1 H) 3.27 (dd, J=10.39, 1.10 Hz, 1 H)
3.36 - 3.44 (m, 1 H) 3.62 - 3.71 (m, 1 H) 3.81 (dd, J=10.45, 4.71 Hz, 1 H) 4.32 -
4.40 (m, 1 H) 4.99 (d, J=3.42 Hz, 1 H) 6.93 (d, J=8.80 Hz, 1 H) 7.33 (d, J=9.05 Hz,
2 H) 7.82 - 7.91 (m, 3 H) 8.14 (d, J=2.20 Hz, 1 H) 10.21 (s, 1 H).
Stage 20.2: 3-Bromo-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-4-fluorobenzamide
[0410]

[0411] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Stage 1.3 using 3-bromo-4-fluorobenzoic acid and 4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)aniline to afford
an off-white solid. UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.25 min, m/z = 394.0 [M+H]
+, m/z = 391.9 [M-H]
-; 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 7.37 (d, J=9.17 Hz, 2 H) 7.57 (t, J=8.68 Hz, 1 H) 7.84 - 7.91 (m, 2 H) 8.03
(ddd, J=8.62, 4.83, 2.32 Hz, 1 H) 8.32 (dd, J=6.60, 2.20 Hz, 1 H) 10.52 (s, 1 H).
Example 21
(S)-6-(3-(Aminomethyl)pyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0412]

[0413] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Example 8 using (S)-tert-butyl ((1-(3-bromo-5-((4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)carbamoyl)-pyridin-2-yl)pyrrolidin-3-yl)methyl)carbamate
(
Stage 21.1) and 1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole
to afford an off-white powder. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 4.15 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.78 min, m/z = 463.1 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.50 - 1.62 (m, 1 H) 1.91 (d, J=6.26 Hz, 1 H) 2.27 (s, 1 H) 2.72 (d, J=7.04
Hz, 2 H) 3.04 - 3.16 (m, 3 H) 3.30 (br. s, 2 H) 3.47 (dd, J=11.34, 7.04 Hz, 1 H) 6.38
(d, J=1.96 Hz, 2 H) 7.31 (d, J=8.60 Hz, 2 H) 7.64 - 7.91 (m, 2 H) 8.05 (d, J=2.35
Hz, 1 H) 8.72 (d, J=1.95 Hz, 1 H) 10.19 (s, 1 H) 12.86 - 13.01 (m, 1 H).
Stage 21.1: (S)-tert-Butyl ((1-(3-bromo-5-((4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-carbamoyl)pyridin-2-yl)pyrrolidin-3-yl)methyl)carbamate
[0414]

[0415] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Stage 8.1 using 5-bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide (
Stage 9.3) and (R)-1-pyrrolidin-3-ylmethyl-carbamic acid tert-butyl ester to afford a crystalline
solid. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 6.09 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.36 min, m/z = 577.2 [M+H]
+.
Example 22
(R)-N-(4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-4-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-3-(3-methyl-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)benzamide
[0416]

[0417] 3-Methyl-1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole
(
Stage 23.1, 128 mg, 0.329 mmol), K
3PO
4 (140 mg, 0.658 mmol) and Pd(PPh
3)
4 (15.22 mg, 0.013 mmol) were added to a solution of (R)-3-bromo-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-4-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)benzamide
(
Stage 20.1, 80 mg, 0.165 mmol) in toluene (1.5 mL) under an argon atmosphere, and the RM was
heated at 110°C for 2 h. The solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure and
the residue was dissolved in DCM (4 mL) and treated with TFA (0.507 mL, 6.58 mmol)
and stirred at RT for 2 h. The RM was treated with sat. aq. Na
2CO
3 (20 mL) and extracted with EtOAc. The combined extracts were washed with brine (20
mL), dried over Na
2SO
4, and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a crude product
which was purified by preparative HPLC (Condition 10 - 20% to 80% B in 20 min). Fractions
containing pure product were combined, treated with sat. aq. Na
2CO
3 and the MeCN was evaporated off under reduced pressure. The aq. residue was extracted
with DCM and the combined extracts were dried over Na
2SO
4, filtered and the filtrate was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a residue
which was crystallized from DCM / n-hexane to give the title product as a white solid.
HPLC (Condition 5) t
R = 6.41 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.03 min, m/z = 463 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.67 - 1.78 (m, 1 H) 1.84 (s, 1 H) 2.16 - 2.30 (m, 3 H) 2.74 (d, J=10.56 Hz,
1 H) 3.04 - 3.33 (m, 3 H) 4.14 - 4.23 (m, 1 H) 4.76 - 4.87 (m, 1 H) 6.07 (s, 1 H)
6.73 - 6.86 (m, 1 H) 7.29 (d, J=8.21 Hz, 2 H) 7.78 - 7.90 (m, J=8.99 Hz, 4 H) 10.07
(s, 1 H) 12.34 - 12.56 (m, 1 H).
Example 23
(R)-N-(4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(3-methyl-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0418]

[0419] 3-Methyl-1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole
(
Stage 23.1, 150 mg, 0.359 mmol), K
3PO
4 (147 mg, 0.692 mmol) and Pd(PPh
3)
4 (15.98 mg, 0.014 mmol) were added to a solution of (R)-5-Bromo-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 9.2, 80 mg, 0.173 mmol) in toluene (1.5 mL) under an argon atmosphere and the RM was stirred
at 110°C for 2 h. The solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure and the residue
was dissolved in DCM (1.5 mL), treated with TFA (0.533 mL, 6.92 mmol) and stirred
at RT for 2 h. The RM was treated with sat. aq. Na
2CO
3 (20 mL) and extracted with EtOAc. The combined extracts were washed with brine (20
mL), dried over Na
2SO
4, and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a crude product
which was purified by flash chromatography (Silica gel column, 12 g, DCM / MeOH from
99:1 to 92:8)and crystallized from DCM / n-hexane to give the title product as a white
solid. HPLC (Condition 5) t
R = 5.92 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.94 min, m/z = 464.1 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.67 - 1.89 (m, 2 H) 2.19 - 2.31 (m, 3 H) 2.98 (d, J=10.95 Hz, 1 H) 3.24 -
3.35 (m, 2 H) 3.39 - 3.52 (m, 1 H) 4.16 - 4.25 (m, 1 H) 4.80 - 4.90 (m, 1 H) 6.11
- 6.17 (m, 1 H) 7.32 (d, J=8.60 Hz, 2 H) 7.87 (d, J=8.99 Hz, 2 H) 7.97 - 8.06 (m,
1 H) 8.66 - 8.78 (m, 1 H) 10.16 (s, 1 H) 12.51 - 12.70 (m, 1 H).
Stage 23.1: 3-Methyl-1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole
[0420]

[0421] A mixture of 3-methylpyrazole (3.0 g, 35.4 mmol), 3,4-dihydro-2H-pyrane (4.97 mL,
53.2 mmol) and TFA (0.02 mL, 0.260 mmol) was stirred at 85°C for 6 h under an argon
atmosphere. The RM was cooled to RT and NaH 60% in mineral oil (0.061 g, 1.524 mmol)
was and the RM was stirred for 10 min. The RM was purified by bulb-to-bulb distillation
to give 3-methyl-1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole (b.p. 150-170°C/ 12 mbar).
A solution of n-BuLi in n-hexane (3.38 mL of 1.6 M, 5.41 mmol) was added dropwise
over 10 min to a solution of 3-methyl-1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole (1.0
g, 5.41 mmol) in THF (12 mL) at - 70°C under a nitrogen atmosphere and The RM was
stirred for 10 min and then treated dropwise with 2-methoxy-4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolane
(0.898 g, 5.69 mmol) and stirred at - 70°C for 1 h. The RM was allowed to warm to
RT, treated with n-hexane and the product was filtered, dissolved in water (10 mL)
and acidified to pH 6 with aqueous citric acid (10%). The water was evaporated off
under reduced pressure and the aqueous residue extracted with EtOAc, dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give the title product
as a yellow resin. UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.56 min, m/z = 211.2 [M+H]
+.
Example 24
(R)-N-(4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-3-(4-fluoro-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)-4-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)benzamide
[0422]

[0423] A mixture of N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-4-fluoro-3-(4-fluoro-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)benzamide
(
Stage 24.1, 62 mg, 0.147 mmol), R-3-hydroxypyrrolidine (0.031 mL, 0.206 mmol) and TEA (0.062
mL, 0.442 mmol) in DMSO (0.5 mL) was stirred at 100°C for 16 h. The RM was diluted
with EtOAc (30 mL), treated with sat. aq. Na
2CO
3 (20 mL)and extracted with EtOAc. The combined extracts were washed with water (20
mL) and brine (20 mL), dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a crude product
which was purified by preparative HPLC (Condition 10). Fractions containing pure product
were combined, treated with sat. aq. Na
2CO
3 and the MeCN was removed under reduced pressure. The aq. residue was extracted with
DCM and the combined extracts were dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved
in DCM and treated with n-hexane to give the title product as a white solid. HPLC
(Condition 5) t
R = 6.61 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.01 min, m/z = 467.3 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.69 - 1.95 (m, 2 H) 2.79 (d, J=10.56 Hz, 1 H) 3.06 - 3.20 (m, 2 H) 3.22 -
3.35 (m, 1 H) 4.13 - 4.30 (m, 1 H) 4.79 - 4.96 (m, 1 H) 6.75 - 6.92 (m, 1 H) 7.31
(d, J=8.60 Hz, 2 H) 7.86 (m, J=9.38 Hz, 5 H) 10.11 (s, 1 H) 12.67 - 13.12 (m, 1 H).
Stage 24.1: N-(4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-4-fluoro-3-(4-fluoro-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)benzamide
[0424]

[0425] A mixture of 3-bromo-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-4-fluorobenzamide
(Stage 20.2, 200 mg, 0.497 mmol), 4-fluoro-5-(tributylstannyl)-1H-pyrazole (211 mg, 0.472 mmol)
and Pd(PPh3)4 (28,7 mg, 0.025 mmol) in DMSO (1.5 mL) in a sealed vial was stirred
at 100°C for 20 h under an argon atmosphere. The RM was diluted with EtOAc (30 mL),
treated with sat. aq. Na
2CO
3 (20 mL) and extracted with EtOAc. The combined extracts were washed with water(20
mL) and brine (20 mL), dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a crude product
which was purified by flash chromatography (Silica gel column, 12 g, n-hexane / EtOAc
95:5 to 6:4) to give the title product as a white solid. HPLC (Condition 5) t
R = 7.20 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.12 min, m/z = 400.1 [M+H]
+.
Example 25
(R)-N-(4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-5-(4-fluoro-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
[0426]

[0427] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Example 5 using 6-chloro-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-5-(4-fluoro-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 25.1) and (R)-pyrrolidin-3-ol to afford a white powder. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 4.89 min, HPLC Chiral (CHIRALCEL® OD-H, 250 x 4.6 mm, eluent: n-heptane/EtOH/MeOH
(85:10:5), 1 mL/min, UV 210 nm) t
R = 9.34 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.96 min, m/z = 468.1 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.67 - 1.92 (m, 2 H) 3.00 (d, J=11.73 Hz, 1 H) 3.19 - 3.33 (m, 2 H) 3.43 (m,
J=7.00 Hz, 1 H) 4.22 (br. s, 1 H) 4.87 (br. s, 1 H) 7.31 (d, J=8.60 Hz, 2 H) 7.85
(d, J=8.99 Hz, 2 H) 7.90 - 8.10 (m, 2 H) 8.77 (br. s, 1 H) 10.18 (s, 1 H) 12.83 -
13.19 (m, 1 H).
Stage 25.1: 6-Chloro-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-5-(4-fluoro-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0428]

[0429] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Stage 13.1 using 6-chloro-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-5-iodonicotinamide (
Stage 25.2) and 4-fluoro-5-(tributylstannyl)-1H-pyrazole to afford an off-white powder. HPLC
(Condition 4) t
R = 5.69 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.09 min, m/z = 415 [M-H]
-;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm .
Stage 25.2: 6-Chloro-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-5-iodonicotinamide
[0430]

[0431] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Stage 11.2 using 6-chloro-5-iodonicotinic acid and 4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)aniline to afford
an off-white powder. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 6.47 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.26 min, m/z = 456.8 [M-H]
-.
Example 26
(R)-N-(4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(3-(trifluoromethyl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0432]

[0433] K
3PO
4 (135 mg, 0.635 mmol), 1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-3-(trifluoromethyl)-1H-pyrazol-5-ylboronic
acid (112 mg, 0.424 mmol) and Pd(PPh
3)
4 (12.24 mg, 10.59 µmοl) were added to a solution of (R)-5-bromo-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 9.2, 100 mg, 0.212 mmol) in toluene (2 mL) and the RM was stirred at 110°C for 2 h under
an argon atmosphere. The RM was filtered through Hyflo®, washed with water and the
solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give the crude product which
was purified by flash chromatography (Silica gel column, 12g, DCM / EtOH from 99:1
to 94:6). The resulting intermediate was dissolved in DCM (2 mL), treated with TFA
(0.462 mL, 5.99 mmol) and stirred for 1 h at RT. The RM was diluted with EtOAc (20
mL), treated with sat. aq. Na
2CO
3 (20 mL) and extracted with EtOAc. The combined extracts were washed with brine (20
mL), dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a crude product
which was purified by flash chromatography (Silica gel column, 4 g, DCM / EtOH from
99:1 to 9:1). Fractions containing pure product were combined and the solvent was
evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a residue which was triturated in DCM/
n-hexane, filtered and dried to give the title product as a white solid. HPLC (Condition
5) t
R = 6.545 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.10 min, m/z = 518.1 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.71 - 1.95 (m, 2 H) 2.94 (d, J=11.34 Hz, 1 H) 3.24 (m, 2 H) 3.44 (m, 1 H)
4.17 - 4.32 (m, 1 H) 4.91 (br. s, 1 H) 6.88 (s, 1 H) 7.34 (d, J=8.21 Hz, 2 H) 7.86
(d, J=9.38 Hz, 2 H) 8.12 (s, 1 H) 8.81 (s, 1 H) 10.17 (s, 1 H) 13.94 (s, 1 H).
Example 27
(R)-N-(4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0434]

[0435] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Stage 2.1 using (R)-5-bromo-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 9.2) and 1-methyl-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole to afford
a white powder. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 5.25 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.98 min, m/z = 464.1 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.65 - 1.89 (m, 2 H) 2.87 - 3.00 (m, 1 H) 3.09 - 3.29 (m, 3 H) 3.59 (s, 3
H) 4.19 (br. s, 1 H) 4.87 (d, J=3.13 Hz, 1 H) 6.39 (s, 1 H) 7.27 - 7.36 (m, 2 H) 7.50
(dd, J=1.76, 0.98 Hz, 1 H) 7.78 - 7.88 (m, 2 H) 8.00 (d, J=2.35 Hz, 1 H) 8.78 (dd,
J=2.35, 1.17 Hz, 1 H) 10.15 (s, 1 H).
Example 28
(R)-N-(4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)nicotinamide
[0436]

[0437] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Stage 2.1 using (R)-5-bromo-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 9.2) and 1-methyl-3-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole to afford
a white powder. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 5.16 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.98 min, m/z = 464 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.64 - 1.90 (m, 2 H) 2.85 - 3.00 (m, 1 H) 3.06 - 3.26 (m, 3 H) 3.59 (s, 3
H) 4.19 (br. s, 1 H) 4.87 (d, J=2.74 Hz, 1 H) 6.39 (s, 1 H) 7.31 (d, J=8.60 Hz, 2
H) 7.50 (dd, J=1.76, 0.98 Hz, 1 H) 7.84 (d, J=8.60 Hz, 2 H) 8.01 (d, J=2.74 Hz, 1
H) 8.78 (dd, J=2.54, 0.98 Hz, 1 H) 10.15 (s, 1 H).
Example 29
(R)-N-(4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-5-(1-(2-hydroxyethyl)-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
[0438]

[0439] 2M Na
2CO
3 (0.375 mL, 0.75 mmol) was added to a solution of (R)-5-bromo-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 9.2, 116 mg, 0.25 mmol) and 1-(2-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yloxy)ethyl)-4-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole
(161 mg, 0.5 mmol) in DME (1.0 mL).under an argon atmosphere. PdCl
2(dppf) (9.15 mg, 0.013 mmol) was then added and the RM mixture was stirred at 100°C
for 2 h. After cooling at RT, the RM was dissolved in EtOAc and washed with brine,
dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure. The crude product was
dissolved in DCM (1.4 mL) cooled to 0°C, then treated with TFA (0.77 mL, 10 mmol)
and stirred at RT for 3 h. The RM was poured into aq. Na
2CO
3 10% (15 mL) and extracted with EtOAc. The combined extracts were dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give the crude product
which was purified by flash chromatography (RediSep® Silica gel column, DCM / MeOH,
from 2% to 10% MeOH) to afford an off-white powder. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 4.33 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.88 min, m/z = 494 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.67 - 1.88 (m, 2 H) 2.96 (d, J=11.73 Hz, 0 H) 3.24 - 3.37 (m, 2 H) 3.41 -
3.53 (m, 1 H) 3.75 (q, J=5.73 Hz, 2 H) 4.04 - 4.25 (m, 4 H) 4.81 (d, J=3.52 Hz, 1
H) 4.86 - 4.94 (m, 1 H) 7.31 (d, J=8.21 Hz, 2 H) 7.53 - 7.59 (m, 1 H) 7.79 - 7.89
(m, 3 H) 7.93 (d, J=2.35 Hz, 1 H) 8.65 (dd, J=2.35, 0.78 Hz, 1 H) 10.15 (s, 1 H).
Example 30
(R)-N-(4-(1,1-Difluoroethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0440]

[0441] K
3PO
4 (113 mg, 0.532 mmol), 1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole
(99 mg, 0.355 mmol) and Pd(PPh
3)
4 (10.24 mg, 8.86 µmοl) were added to a solution of (R)-5-bromo-N-(4-(1,1-difluoroethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 30.1, 80 mg, 0.177 mmol) in toluene (1.5 mL) under argon atmosphere, and the RM was stirred
at 110°C for 1 h. The RM was diluted with EtOAc (20 mL) treated with sat. NaHCO
3 solution (20 mL). and extracted with EtOAc. The combined extracts were washed with
brine (20 mL), dried with Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a crude product
which was purified by flash chromatography (Silica gel column, 12 g DCM / EtOH from
97:3to 95:5) to afford N-(4-(1,1-difluoroethoxy)phenyl)-6-((R)-3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
which (66 mg, 0.129 mmol)was dissolved in DCM (1.5 mL) and treated with TFA (0.546
mL, 7.09 mmol) and stirred for 2 h at RT. The RM was diluted with EtOAc (20 mL), treated
with sat. NaHCO
3 solution (25 mL) and extracted with EtOAc (20 mL). The combined extracts were washed
with brine (20 mL), dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give the crude product
which was purified by preparative HPLC (Condition 10). Fractions containing pure product
were combined, treated with 0.5g NaHCO
3 and the MeCN was evaporated off under reduced pressure. The aq. residue was extracted
with DCM to give the title product as a white solid. HPLC (Condition 5) t
R = 5.42 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.82 min, m/z = 430.1 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.68 - 1.87 (m, 2 H) 1.93 (t, J=13.67 Hz, 3 H) 2.94 (d, J=11.71 Hz, 1 H) 3.15
- 3.33 (m, 2 H) 3.38 - 3.48 (m, 1 H) 4.19 (br. s, 1 H) 6.37 (s, 1 H) 7.15 (d, J=9.37
Hz, 2 H) 7.65 - 7.83 (m, J=9.37 Hz, 3 H) 8.03 (d, J=2.34 Hz, 1 H) 8.73 (d, J=2.34
Hz, 1 H).
Stage 30.1: (R)-5-Bromo-N-(4-(1,1-difluoroethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
[0442]

[0443] A mixture of 5-bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-(1,1-difluoroethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
(Stage 30.2, 700 mg, 1.752 mmol), (R)-pyrrolidin-3-ol (0.170 mL, 2.102 mmol) and DIPEA (0.673
mL, 3.85 mmol) and iPrOH (2 mL) in a sealed vial was heated to 120°C for 1 h. The
RM was diluted with EtOAc (80 mL), treated with citric acid 10% (40 mL; ∼pH4) and
extracted with EtOAc. The combined extracts were washed with brine (2 x 40 mL), dried
over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a residue which
was washed with Et
2O and n-hexane and the crystals were dried to give the title product as a beige solid.
HPLC (Condition 5) t
R = 6.4 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.02 min, m/z = 442.1/ 444.0 [M+H]
+.
Stage 30.2: 5-Bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-(1,1-difluoroethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0444]

[0445] Oxalyl chloride (653 µL, 7.46 mmol) was added to a mixture of 5-bromo-6-chloronicotinic
acid (1.2 g, 4.97 mmol) and DMF (20 µL, 0.258 mmol) in DCM (40 mL) under nitrogen
atmosphere and the RM was stirred for 2 h at RT. The solvent was evaporated, the residue
was dissolved in DCM (10 mL) and evaporated again to dryness. The residue was dissolved
in THF (30 mL), DIPEA (1.737 mL, 9.95 mmol) was added and the RM was cooled down to
-15°C. 4-(1,1-difluoroethoxy)aniline (
Stage 30.3, 0.932 g, 5.22 mmol) in THF (10 mL) was added dropwise in 15 min. period and the
RM was stirred for 1 h at RT. The solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure
and the residue was diluted with EtOAc (100 mL), treated with citric acid 10% (60
mL)and extracted with EtOAc. The combined extracts were washed with sat. aq. Na
2CO
3 (50 mL) and brine (2 x 50 mL), dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give the crude product
which was suspended in n-hexane, filtered and dried to give the title product as a
beige solid. HPLC (Condition 5) t
R = 7.3 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.16 min, m/z = 391/393 [M+H]
+.
Stage 30.3: 4-(1,1-Difluoroethoxy)aniline
[0446]

[0447] A solution of 1-(1,1-difluoroethoxy)-4-nitrobenzene (
Stage 30.4, 2.95 g, 13.94 mmol) in EtOH (100 mL) was hydrogenated (Raney Ni 1.0 g; 26.5 h at
RT). The RM was filtered through Hyflo® and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced
pressure to give the crude title product as a brown oil. HPLC (Condition 5) t
R = 4.5 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.74 min, m/z = 174.1 [M+H]
+.
Stage 30.4: 1-(1,1-Difluoroethoxy)-4-nitrobenzene
[0448]

[0449] 4-Nitroacetophenone (2.45 g, 14.54 mmol) and HF-pyridine (10.11 mL, 116 mmol) was
added to a mixture of XeF2 (4.92 g, 29.1 mmol) and DCM (50 mL) in a plastic vial and
the RM was stirred at RT for 20 h. The RM was added carefully to a stirred mixture
of EtOAc (150 mL) and sat. NaHCO
3 (250 mL) and extracted with EtOAc. The combined extracts were washed with brine (2
x 100 mL), dried over Na2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a crude product
which was purified by flash chromatography (Silica gel column, 40 g, n-hexane / EtOAc
(95:5)) to give the title product as a yellow oil. HPLC (Condition 5) t
R = 6.9 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.05 min.
Example 31
(R)-N-(4-(2-Chloro-1,1,2,2-tetrafluoroethyl)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0450]

[0451] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Example 8 using (R)-5-bromo-N-(4-(2-chloro-1,1,2,2-tetrafluoroethyl)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 31.1) and 1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole
to afford a white powder. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 4.89 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.98 min, m/z = 484.1 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.65 - 1.89 (m, 2 H) 2.83 - 2.98 (m, 1 H) 3.18 - 3.33 (m, 2 H) 3.36 - 3.49
(m, 1 H) 4.13 - 4.24 (m, 1 H) 4.77 - 4.93 (m, 1 H) 6.31 - 6.43 (m, 1 H) 7.62 (d, J=8.59
Hz, 2 H) 7.77 - 7.84 (m, 1 H) 7.91 - 8.09 (m, 3 H) 8.64 - 8.81 (m, 1 H) 10.31 (s,
1 H) 12.83 - 12.96 (m, 1 H).
Stage 31.1: (R)-5-Bromo-N-(4-(2-chloro-1,1,2,2-tetrafluoroethyl)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
[0452]

[0453] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Stage 8.1 using 5-bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-(2-chloro-1,1,2,2-tetrafluoroethyl)phenyl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 31.2) and (R)-pyrrolidin-3-ol to afford a white powder. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 6.05 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.18 min, m/z = 498 [M+H]
+.
Stage 31.2: 5-Bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-(2-chloro-1,1,2,2-tetrafluoroethyl)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0454]

[0455] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Stage 9.3 using 5-bromo-6-chloronicotinic acid and 4-(2-chloro-1,1,2,2-tetrafluoroethyl)aniline
(
Stage 31.3) to afford a beige crystalline powder. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 6.77 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.31 min, m/z = 444.8 [M+H]
+.
Stage 31.3: 4-(2-Chloro-1,1,2,2-tetrafluoroethyl)aniline
[0456]

[0457] Ni(PPh3)
4 (222 mg, 0.2 mmol) was added to a mixture of aniline (745 mg, 8 mmol) and 1-chloro-1,1,2,2-tetrafluoro-2-iodoethane
(1049 mg, 4 mmol) in DMF (10 mL)in a MW vial under an argon atmosphere. The vial was
sealed and the RM was stirred for two days at 80°C. After cooling at RT, the RM was
dissolved in Et
2O, washed with NaHCO
3 10% and brine, dried over MgSO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduce pressure to give a residue which
was purified by flash chromatography (RediSep® Silica gel column, n-heptane / EtOAc,
from 0 to 25% EtOAc) and further by reverse phase chromatography (MPLC, Lichroprep®
15-25 µm column, eluents: water + 0.1% formic / MeCN + 0.1% formic acid, gradient
10 to 50% MeCN + 0.1% formic acid). The fractions containing pure product were combined
and the MeCN was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give an aq. phase which
was neutralized with NaHCO
3 and extracted with Et
2O. The combined extracts were dried over MgSO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to afford the title compound
as a red oil. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 5.48 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.04 min, m/z = 269 [M+H]
+.
Example 32
(R)-6-(3-Hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)-N-(6-((trifluoromethyl)thio)pyridin-3-yl)nicotinamide
[0458]

[0459] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Example 8 using (R)-5-bromo-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(6-((trifluoromethyl)thio)pyridin-3-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 32.1) and 1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole
to afford an off-white powder. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 4.18 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.82 min, m/z = 451.3 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.64 - 1.89 (m, 2 H) 2.94 (d, J=11.73 Hz, 1 H) 3.18 - 3.33 (m, 2 H) 3.36 -
3.49 (m, 1 H) 4.18 (br. s, 1 H) 4.81 (d, J=3.13 Hz, 1 H) 6.38 (s, 1 H) 7.68 - 7.85
(m, 2 H) 8.02 (d, J=1.95 Hz, 1 H) 8.32 (dd, J=8.60, 2.35 Hz, 1 H) 8.73 (d, J=2.35
Hz, 1 H) 8.98 (d, J=2.35 Hz, 1 H) 10.42 (s, 1 H) 12.89 - 13.12 (m, 1 H).
Stage 32.1: (R)-5-Bromo-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(6-((trifluoromethyl)thio)pyridin-3-yl)nicotinamide
[0460]

[0461] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Stage 8.1 using 5-bromo-6-chloro-N-(6-((trifluoromethyl)thio)pyridin-3-yl)nicotinamide (
Stage 32.2) and (R)-pyrrolidin-3-ol to afford an off-white powder. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 5.53 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.01 min, m/z = 463.1 [M+H]
+.
Stage 32.2: 5-Bromo-6-chloro-N-(6-((trifluoromethyl)thio)pyridin-3-yl)nicotinamide
[0462]

[0463] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Stage 9.3 using 5-bromo-6-chloronicotinic acid and 6-(trifluoromethylthio)pyridin-3-amine to
afford an off-white powder. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 6.43 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.15 min, m/z = 411.9 [M-H]
-.
Example 33
(R)-N-(4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(4-methyl-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0464]

[0465] DIPEA (77 µL, 0.44 mmol) was added to a solution of 6-chloro-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-5-(4-methyl-1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 33.1, 99 mg, 0.2 mmol) and (R)-pyrrolidin-3-ol, 20.9 mg, 0.24 mmol) in iPrOH (200 µL) in
a vial, which was sealed and the RM mixture was stirred at 140°C for 1.5 h. After
cooling at RT, the RM was dissolved in EtOAc, washed with brine, dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved
in DCM (1.1 mL), cooled to 0°C, treated with TFA (0.616 mL, 8 mmol) and stirred at
RT for 3 h. The RM was poured in to 10% aq. Na
2CO
3 (10 mL) and extracted with EtOAc. The combined extracts were dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a residue which
was purified by flash chromatography (RediSep® silica gel column, DCM / MeOH from
2% to 10% MeOH) to afford the title compound as a beige powder. HPLC (Condition 4)
t
R = 4.79 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.95 min, m/z = 464 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.63 - 1.92 (m, 5 H) 2.81 - 2.96 (m, 1 H) 3.05 - 3.41 (m, 3 H) 4.17 (br. s,
1 H) 4.81 (br. s, 1 H) 7.30 (d, J=8.60 Hz, 2 H) 7.58 (s, 1 H) 7.79 - 8.02 (m, 3 H)
8.73 (s, 1 H) 10.15 (s, 1 H) 12.58 - 12.85 (m, 1 H).
Stage 33.1: 6-Chloro-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-5-(4-methyl-1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0466]

[0467] K
3PO
4 (191 mg, 0.9 mmol) and Pd(PPh
3)
4 (17.33 mg, 0.015 mmol) were added to a solution of 6-Chloro-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-5-iodonicotinamide
(
Stage 25.2, 138 mg, 0.3 mmol) and 4-methyl-1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole
(131 mg, 0.45 mmol) in toluene (1.5 mL) under an argon atmosphere in a vial, which
was sealed and heated at 110°C for 18 h. The RM was poured into 20 mL water and extracted
with EtOAc. The combined extracts were dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a residue which
was purified by flash chromatography (RediSep® Silica gel column, n-heptane / EtOAc,
from 5 to 50% EtOAc) and crystallized from n-heptane to afford the title compound
as an off-white powder. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 6.8 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.26 min, m/z = 495 [M-H]
-.
Example 34
(S)-6-(3-Hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0468]

[0469] The title compound was prepared in analogous fashion to that described in
Example 8 using (S)-5-bromo-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 34.1) and 1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole
to afford an off-white powder. HPLC (Condition 4) t
R = 4.42 min, HPLC Chiral (CHIRALPAK® AD-H, 250 x 4.6 mm, eluent: EtOH / MeCN (98:2),
0.5 mL/min, UV 210 nm) t
R = 28.27 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.91 min, m/z = 434.2 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.63 - 1.88 (m, 2 H) 2.92 (d, J=11.73 Hz, 1 H) 3.19 - 3.29 (m, 2 H) 3.34 -
3.47 (m, 1 H) 4.18 (br. s, 1 H) 4.80 (d, J=3.13 Hz, 1 H) 6.37 (s, 1 H) 7.31 (d, J=8.99
Hz, 2 H) 7.75 - 7.89 (m, 3 H) 8.00 (d, J=2.35 Hz, 1 H) 8.71 (d, J=2.35 Hz, 1 H) 10.16
(s, 1 H) 12.85 - 13.12 (m, 1 H).
Stage 34.1: (S)-5-Bromo-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
[0470]

[0471] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Stage 8.1 using 5-bromo-6-chloro-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide (
Stage 2.3) and (S)-pyrrolidin-3-ol to afford an off-white crystalline powder. HPLC (Condition
4) t
R = 5.83 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.06 min, m/z = 446.1 [M+H]
+.
Example 35
(S)-N-(4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-5-(4-fluoro-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)nicotinamide
[0472]

[0473] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Example 5 using 6-chloro-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-5-(4-fluoro-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 25.1) and (S)-3-pyrrolidinol to afford a white solid. HPLC (Condition 5) t
R = 5.69 min, HPLC Chiral (CHIRALCEL® OD-H, 250 x 4.6 mm, eluent: n-heptane/EtOH/MeOH
(85:10:5), 1 mL/min, UV 210 nm) t
R = 12.62 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 6) t
R = 0.97 min, m/z = 468.2 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.71 - 1.81 (m, 1 H) 1.81 - 1.92 (m, 1 H) 3.02 (d, J=11.34 Hz, 1 H) 3.24 -
3.37 (m, 2 H) 3.40 - 3.49 (m, 1 H) 4.23 (br. s, 1 H) 4.89 (br. s, 1 H) 7.32 (d, J=9.4
Hz, 2 H) 7.76 - 7.98 (m, J=9.00 Hz, 3 H) 8.03 (d, J=2.35 Hz, 1 H) 8.79 (d, J=2.35
Hz, 1 H) 10.20 (br. s, 1 H) 12.99 (br. s, 1 H).
Example 36
Methyl 1-(5-((4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)carbamoyl)-3-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)pyridin-2-yl)pyrrolidine-3-carboxylate
[0474]

[0475] DIPEA (181 µL, 1.035 mmol) was added to a mixture of 6-chloro-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-5-(1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 36.1, 100 mg, 0.207 mmol), methyl-3-pyrrolidine carboxylate hydrochloride (44.5 mg, 0.269
mmol) and iPrOH (414 µL).in MW vial, which was flushed with argon, sealed and stirred
at 130°C for 24 h. The RM was diluted with EtOAc, treated with brine and extracted
with EtOAc. The combined extracts were dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give the crude product
which was purified by flash chromatography (Silica gel column, n-heptane / EtOAc from
40% to 100% EtOAc) followed by preparative TLC (Silica gel, eluent EtOAc). Additional
lyophilization from 1,4-dioxane afforded the title compound as a white light solid.
UPLC-MS (Condition 6) t
R = 1.09 min, m/z = 492.1 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.90 - 2.02 (m, 1 H) 2.02 - 2.14 (m, 1 H) 3.06 - 3.20 (m, 1 H) 3.23 - 3.48
(m, 4 H) 3.61 (s, 3 H) 6.35 - 6.48 (m, 1 H) 7.34 (d, J=8.78 Hz, 2 H) 7.79 - 7.90 (m,
1 H) 7.89 (d, J=8.80 Hz, 2 H) 8.03 - 8.13 (m, 1 H) 8.70 - 8.83 (m, 1 H) 10.26 (s,
1 H).
Stage 36.1: 6-Chloro-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-5-(1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0476]

[0477] 1-(Tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-5-boronic acid pinacol ester (9.45 g, 34.0
mmol), Na
2CO
3 (39.2 mL, 78 mmol) and PdCl
2(dppf) (0.956 g, 1.307 mmol) were added to 6-chloro-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-5-iodonicotinamide
(
Stage 25.2, 12 g, 26.1 mmol) in DME (160 mL).The mixture was evacuated / purged 3 times with
argon, and stirred at 80°C for 22 h. The RM was diluted with EtOAc (350 mL), washed
with water (4 x 150 mL) and extracted with EtOAc. The combined extracts were dried
over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give the crude product
which was purified by flash chromatography (Silica gel column, 850 g, EtOAc / n-hexane
(1:2)) and crystallized from iPr
2O / EtOAc to give the title product as a white solid. HPLC (Condition 5) t
R = 7.52 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.22 min, m/z = 483/485 [M+H]
+.
Example 37
1-(5-((4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)carbamoyl)-3-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)pyridin-2-yl)pyrrolidine-3-carboxylic
acid
[0478]

[0479] Aq. 1 M LiOH (0.199 mL, 0.199 mmol) was added to a solution of methyl 1-(5-((4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)carbamoyl)-3-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)pyridin-2-yl)pyrrolidine-3-carboxylate
(
Example 36, 24.5 mg, 0.05 mmol) in MeOH (0.5 mL) / THF (1 mL) and the RM was stirred at RT for 1 h
20. The RM was treated with 1 M HCl (4 eq.) and organic solvents were evaporated off
under reduced pressure. The aq. phase was extracted twice with EtOAc and the combined
extracts were washed with brine, dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was concentrated under reduced pressure to a volume of 0.5 mL. n-Heptane
was added and the product was filtered, washed with n-heptane and dried to afford
the title compound as beige solid. UPLC-MS (Condition 6) t
R = 0.96 min, m/z = 478.3 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.86 - 2.12 (m, 2 H) 2.90 - 3.09 (m, 1 H) 3.17 - 3.54 (m, 4 H) 6.41 (d, J=2.08
Hz, 1 H) 7.34 (d, J=9.05 Hz, 2 H) 7.66 - 7.83 (m, 1 H) 7.88 (d, J=9.17 Hz, 2 H) 8.06
(d, J=2.44 Hz, 1 H) 8.70 - 8.84 (m, 1 H) 10.23 (s, 1 H) 12.90 (br. s, 1 H).
Example 38
(S)-(R)-1-(5-((4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)carbamoyl)-3-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)pyridin-2-yl)pyrrolidin-3-yl
2-amino-3-methylbutanoate
[0480]

[0481] Boc-L-Valine (726 mg, 3.34 mmol) and DMAP (102 mg, 0.836 mmol) were added to a mixture
of (R)-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(
Example 9, 800 mg, 1.672 mmol) in DCM (20 mL) and the suspension was stirred at RT for 30 min.
N,N'-Diisopropyl carbodiimide (0.521 mL, 3.34 mmol) was then added and the resulting
solution was stirred at RT for 19 h. The RM was diluted with EtOAc (150 mL), washed
with aq. sat. NaHCO
3 solution (50 mL) and brine (2 x 50 mL) and extracted with EtOAc. The combined extracts
were dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a residue which
was suspended in EtOAc (5 mL), stirred at RT, filtered and washed with 10 mL EtOAc.
The filtrate was evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure and the resulting intermediate
was dissolved in DCM (15 mL), treated with TFA (4.09 mL, 53.0 mmol) and was stirred
at RT for 92 h. The solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure and the residue
was dissolved in EtOAc (150 mL), washed with aq. sat. NaHCO
3 solution (50 mL) and with water (2 x 50 mL), dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a residue which
was dissolved in MeOH (20 mL), and treated with Si-Thiol (Biotage 1.3 mmol/g, 1 g).
Silica gel (5 g) was added to the mixture, the solvent was evaporated off under reduce
pressure, and the residue was purified by flash chromatography (RediSep® Silica gel
column, 120 g, DCM / MeOH 95:5) followed by preparative SFC (Column DEAP; isocratic
25% in 15 min). The fractions containing pure product were combined and the solvent
was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a residue which was dissolved in
hot MeOH (4 mL) and filtered through a PTFE 0.45 µm filter. The filtrate was sonicated
for 5 min and the resulting white suspension was stirred for 2 h at RT, filtered,
washed with MeOH (1 mL) and dried to give the title product as a white solid. HPLC
(Condition 5) t
R = 5.41 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 0.86 min, m/z = 549.2 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 0.77 (d, J=6.65 Hz, 3 H) 0.81 (d, J=6.65 Hz, 3 H) 1.51 - 1.64 (m, 2 H) 1.69
- 1.81 (m, 1 H) 1.84 - 1.94 (m, 1 H) 1.98 - 2.12 (m, 1 H) 3.02 (d, J=5.08 Hz, 1 H)
3.15 (d, J=12.90 Hz, 1 H) 3.30 - 3.43 (m, 2 H) 3.46 - 3.57 (m, 1 H) 5.13 - 5.25 (m,
1 H) 6.39 (br. s, 1 H) 7.31 (d, J=8.21 Hz, 2 H) 7.76 - 7.91 (m, 3 H) 8.05 (s, 1 H)
8.73 (br. s, 1 H) 10.21 (s, 1 H) 12.94 (br. s, 1 H).
Example 39
(R)-1-(5-((4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)carbamoyl)-3-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)pyridin-2-yl)pyrrolidin-3-yl
dihydrogen phosphate
[0482]

[0483] TFA (1.227 mL, 15.93 mmol) was added to a solution of N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-((R)-3-((3-oxido-1,5-dihydrobenzo[e][1,3,2]dioxaphosphepin-3-yl)oxy)pyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 39.1, 620 mg, 0.797 mmol) in DCM (10 mL)and the RM was stirred for 20 h at RT. Additional
TFA (500µL) was added and the RM was stirred for further 4 h at RT. The RM was diluted
with EtOAc (100 mL), treated with sat. aq. Na
2CO
3 (70 mL) and extracted with EtOAc (50 mL). The combined extracts were washed with
brine (50 mL), dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give a residue which
was purified by flash chromatography (Silica gel column, 12 g DCM /EtOH from 9:1 to
4:6). The intermediate was dissolved in MeOH / THF (10 mL of 1:1) and hydrogenated
(60 mg Pd/C 5%, 0.1 bar, 22-25°C, 6.5 h). The RM was filtered through Hyflo® and solvent
was evaporated off under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in MeOH / THF
and was treated with a PL-Thiol MP SPE cartridge (StratoSpheres™). The resin was filtered
off and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give the title product.
HPLC (Condition 5) t
R = 5.50 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 6) t
R = 0.76 min, m/z = 530.2 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.88 - 2.08 (m, 2 H) 3.12 - 3.48 (m, 4 H) 4.73 (br. s, 1 H) 6.37 - 6.44 (m,
1 H) 7.33 (d, J=8.99 Hz, 2 H) 7.76 (s, 1 H) 7.87 (d, J=8.99 Hz, 2 H) 8.04 - 8.08 (m,
1 H) 8.73 - 8.78 (m, 1 H) 10.21 (s, 1 H).
Stage 39.1: N-(4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-((R)-3-((3-oxido-1,5-dihydrobenzo[e][1,3,2]dioxaphosphepin-3-yl)oxy)pyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
[0484]

[0485] N,N-diethyl-1,5-dihydrobenzo[e][1,3,2]dioxaphosphepin-3-amine (355 mg, 1.483 mmol)
was added to a mixture of N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-((R)-3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1-(tetrahydro-2H-pyran-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 9.1, 200 mg, 0.371 mmol) and tetrazole in MeCN (8.240 mL, 3.71 mmol) in a vial and the RM
was stirred at RT for 3 h. The RM was cooled to 5°C, treated with TEA (0.775 mL, 5.56
mmol) and aq. H
2O
2 (0.379 mL, 3.71 mmol) and was stirred at 0°C for 30 min followed by 3 h at RT. The
RM was quenched with a solution of 10% Na
2S
2O
3 (20 mL) and extracted with EtOAc. The combined extracts were washed with water (20
mL) and brine (15 mL), dried over Na
2SO
4 and the solvent was evaporated off under reduced pressure to give the crude product
which was purified by flash chromatography (Silica gel column, 12 g DCM / MeOH from
98:2 to 9:1) to give the title product as a white foam. HPLC (Condition 5) t
R = 7.3 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 3) t
R = 1.18 min, m/z = 716.3 [M+H]
+.
Example 40
(R)-1-(3-(1H-Pyrazol-5-yl)-5-((4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)carbamoyl)pyridin-2-yl)pyrrolidin-3-yl
dihydrogen phosphate
[0486]

[0487] The title compound was prepared in an analogous fashion to that described in
Example 39 using (R)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-3-yl)-N-(4-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)nicotinamide
(
Stage 2.1) and N,N-diethyl-1,5-dihydrobenzo[e][1,3,2]dioxaphosphepin-3-amine to afford a beige
solid. HPLC (Condition 5) t
R = 5.3 min, UPLC-MS (Condition 6) t
R = 0.75 min - m/z = 514.4 [M+H]
+;
1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d
6) δ ppm 1.88 - 2.07 (m, 2 H) 3.21 - 3.49 (m, 4 H) 4.66 - 4.76 (m, 1 H) 6.41 (d, J=1.96
Hz, 1 H) 7.02 - 7.15 (m, 1 H) 7.34 (d, J=8.68 Hz, 2 H) 7.77 (s, 1 H) 7.87 (d, J=9.05
Hz, 2 H) 8.06 (d, J=2.32 Hz, 1 H) 8.75 (d, J=2.32 Hz, 1 H) 10.21 (s, 1 H).
Example 41
Solid dispersion formulation
[0488] A solid dispersion formulation can be prepared for compounds of the invention where
enhancing their solubility is beneficial for bioavailability and/or permeability.
[0489] The solid dispersion formulation was prepared using an amorphous dispersion of (R)-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(Example 9, see Figure 1) with excipients selected from PVP VA64 and Pharmacoat 603.
First, a solution for spray drying was prepared by mixing (R)-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(Example 9, 2.5 grams) with PVP VA 64 (3.75 grams) and Pharmacoat 603 (3.75 grams).
A mixture of 50/50 methylene chloride/ethanol was added until all components were
dissolved as shown by a clear solution free of particulates and haze (∼200 mL). Alternatively,
the mixture of 50/50 methylene chloride/ethanol can be substituted with an acetone/ethanol/water
(5:4:1) mixture. Spray drying was carried out on a Büchi B290 Mini-spray drier with
an inlet temperature of 70°C, aspiration at 85%, nitrogen flow at 50mm of Hg, pump
at 15% and the nozzle cleaner was zero to yield 5.5 grams (55%). The resultant spray-dried
solid dispersion contained 23.6% Drug Load of (R)-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(Example 9), 37.5% PVP VA64 and 37.5% Pharmacoat 603. The dispersion was amorphous
with a glass transition temperature (T
g) value of 117°C and contained approximately 1.4% water as determined by thermogravimetric
analysis (TGA). Dissolution of this solid dispersion in pH 1 followed by a pH switch
to 6.8 after 30 minutes showed full dissolution under acidic pH. The dispersion remained
fully solubilized after a pH challenge to neutral pH.
[0490] The dispersion was suspended in phosphate buffered saline (PBS) at a concentration
of 3 mg/mL (as drug) for 12 hours at room temperature. No crystallization was noted,
the particle size D (0.9; the diameter of the particle where 90% of the particles
are below this number stated) was 14.134 with very homogeneous and narrow particle
size distribution. The drug did not crystallize out of suspension and no chemical
degradation was noted (as evaluated by UPLC). The suspension had a chemical purity
of 99.4%, which matched the T0 purity of the suspension and the drug itself.
[0491] The enhanced properties of the solid dispersion formulation of (R)-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(
Example 9) in dog can be demonstrated by the table of pharmacokinetic parameters, below.
| Type of formulation |
Solid Dispersion |
Suspension |
| Dose [mg/kg] |
60 |
60 |
| AUC [mM*h] (SD) |
671.9 |
102.9 |
| cMax [nM] (SD) |
47127 |
7314 |
| BAV* [%] (SD) |
179.1 |
27.4 |
| Tmax [h] (SD) |
2.00 |
3.3 |
| Volume of Administration [ml/kg] |
5 |
5 |
| Rank exposure/ cMax |
14.2 |
14.1 |
[0492] The solid dispersion formulation of (R)-N-(4-(chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(Example 9) at a dose of 60 mpk gave 6.5 times more exposure than the crystalline
suspension (671.9 µM versus 102.9 µm).
Assays
[0493] The utility of the compounds of the invention described herein can be evidenced by
testing in the following assays. Compounds of the invention were assessed for their
ability to inhibit ABL1 activity in biochemical assays and BCR-ABL1 in cellular assays
described below. Compounds of the invention were further tested and shown to be efficacious
in vivo using a KCL-22 xenograft model.
Biochemical Assays
[0494] Expression and purification of protein kinase - Expression and purification of human
ABL was performed using standard expression purification procedures. The ABL64-515
protein was generated and used for
in vitro kinase assays. The protein was generated by a co-expression vector carrying the DNA
fragments for ABL1 (1a isoform, with an N-terminal His6-tag followed by a PreScission
protease cleavage site) and the human protein tyrosine phosphatase-1B (residues 1-283,
untagged), using the dual expression vector pCDF Duet-1 (Novagen). The His-ABL was
expressed in
E.coli BL21 (DE3) and the ABL proteins were isolated by Ni-affinity on a Ni-NTA column (Qiagen).
The His-tag was removed by PreScission protease (GE Healthcare) and the non-phosphoprylated
ABL further purified on a Mono Q HR 10/10 (GE Healthcare, mono-phosphorylated ABL
is about 10-20 % of total ABL protein) and HiLoad 16/60 Superdex 200 size exclusion
column (GE Healthcare). Non-phosphorylated ABL64-515 proteins were analyzed by mass
spectroscopic analysis and flash-frozen in aliquots and stored at - 80°C. SRC (amino
acids 83-535 or Src83-535) was expressed and purified as described (
S.W. Cowan-Jacob, G. Fendrich, P.W. Manley, W. Jahnke, D. Fabbro, J. Liebetanz, T.
Meyer, c-Src crystal structure provides insights into c-Src activation. Structure
13 (2005) 861-871).
Radio ABL1 (64-515) assay
[0495] For determination of ABL kinase activity, the radiometric filter-binding assay was
used. The assay was performed by mixing 10 µL of the compound pre-diluted with 10
µL of ATP (20 µM ATP with 0.1 µCi [γ-33P]-ATP) with the phospho-acceptor peptide poly[Ala6Glu2LysHBr5Tyr1]
= polyAEKY) in 20 mM Tris/HCl pH 7.5, 1 mM DTT, 10 mM MgCl
2, 0.01 mM Na
3VO
4, 50 mM NaCl. 10 µL of enzyme (ranging between 5 nM to 20 nM) was added to initiate
the reaction. Pre-incubation of enzyme with compounds (when stated) was performed
by exposing the enzyme to compounds prior to addition of the substrate mixture (ATP
and/or peptide substrate). After 15 min at room temperature, the reaction was stopped
by the addition of 50 µL 125 mM EDTA, and the peptide-bound 33P separated on filter-plates
(PVDF or MAIP; Millipore, Volketswil, Switzerland) prepared according to the manufacturer's
instructions. Filter-plates were washed 3x with 0.5% H
3PO
4, followed by addition of 30 µL scintillation cocktail (Microscint, Perkin Elmer)
per well and then analysed in a TopCount NXT scintillation counter (Perkin Elmer).
Results were expressed as IC
50 values. The K
m values for ATP were determined by assaying the ABL kinase with increasing concentrations
of ATP and keeping the exogenous acceptor protein substrate (poly-AEKY) at a constant
concentration (at about 2-fold its K
m) and
vice versa. K
m and V
max were calculated according to Eadie-Hofstee as described (
D. Fabbro, G. Fendrich, V. Guez, T. Meyer, P. Furet, J. Mestan, J.D. Griffin, P.W.
Manley, S.W. Cowan-Jacob, Targeted therapy with imatinib: An exception or a rule?
Handbook of Experimental Pharmacology 167, Inhibitors of Protein Kinases and Protein
Phosphates (2005) 361-389). The data were plotted as V
versus V/S, where V is the velocity of the reaction at a given substrate (S) concentration,
and fitted to a straight line using linear regression analysis, where the slope of
the line corresponds to -K
m and the Y-intercept represents the V
max.
Caliper ABL1 (64-515) assay
[0496] All assays were performed in 384-well microtiter plates. Each assay plate contained
8-point serial dilutions for 40 test compounds, as well as four 8-point serial dilutions
of staurosporine as a reference compound, plus 16 high and 16 low controls. Liquid
handling and incubation steps were done on a Thermo CatX workstation equipped with
Innovadyne Nanodrop Express. Between pipetting steps, tips were cleaned in wash cycles
using wash buffer.
[0497] The assay plates were prepared by addition of 50 nL per well of compound solution
in 90% DMSO. The kinase reactions were started by stepwise addition of 4.5 µL per
well of peptide/ATP-solution (50 mM HEPES, pH 7.5, 1 mM DTT, 0.02% BSA, 0.6% DMSO,
10 mM beta-glycerophosphate, and 10 µM sodium orthovanadate, 20 mM MgCl
2, 2 mM MnCl
2, 4 µM ATP, 4 µM peptide (FITC-Ahx-EAIYAAPFAKKK-NH2)) and 4.5 µL per well of enzyme
solution (50 mM HEPES, pH 7.5, 1 mM DTT, 0.02% BSA, 0.6% DMSO, 10 mM beta-glycerophosphate,
and 10 µM sodium orthovanadate, 20 mM MgCl
2, 2mM MnCl
2, 3.5 nM ABL (ABL(64-515), produced in-house from E. coli)). Kinase reactions were
incubated at 30°C for 60 minutes and subsequently terminated by addition of 16 µL
per well of stop solution (100 mM HEPES pH 7.5, 5% DMSO, 0.1% Caliper coating reagent,
10 mM EDTA, and 0.015% Brij35). Plates with terminated kinase reactions were transferred
to the Caliper LC3000 workstations for reading. Phosphorylated and unphosphorylated
peptides were separated using the Caliper microfluidic mobility shift technology.
Briefly, samples from terminated kinase reactions were applied to the chip. Analytes
are transported through the chip by constant buffer flow and the migration of the
substrate peptide is monitored by the fluorescence signal of its label. Phosphorylated
peptide (product) and unphosphorylated peptide (substrate) are separated in an electric
field by their charge/mass ratio. Kinase activities were calculated from the amounts
of formed phospho-peptide. IC50 values were determined from percent inhibition values
at different compound concentrations by non-linear regression analysis.
[0498] Preparation of compound dilutions: Test compounds were dissolved in DMSO (10 mM)
and transferred into 1.4mL flat bottom or V-shaped Matrix tubes carrying a unique
2D matrix. The stock solutions were stored at +2°C if not used immediately. For the
test procedure the vials were defrosted and identified by a scanner whereby a working
sheet was generated that guided the subsequent working steps.
[0499] Compound dilutions were made in 96-well plates. This format enabled the assay of
maximally 40 individual test compounds at 8 concentrations (single points) including
4 reference compounds. The dilution protocol included the production of "pre-dilution
plates", "master plates" and "assay plates".
[0500] Pre-dilution plates: Polypropylene 96-well plates were used as pre-dilution plates.
A total of 4 pre-dilution plates were prepared including 10 test compounds each on
the plate positions A1-A10, one standard compound at A11 and one DMSO control at A12.
All dilution steps were done on a HamiltonSTAR robot.
[0501] Master plates: 30 µL of individual compound dilutions including standard compound
and controls of the 4 "pre-dilution plates" were transferred into a 384 "master plate"
including the following concentrations 1'810, 362, 72.5, 54.6, 14.5, 2.9, 0.58 and
0.12µM, respectively in 90% of DMSO.
[0502] Assay plates: Identical "assay plates" were then prepared by pipetting 50nL each
of compound dilutions of the "master plates" into 384-well "assay plates" by means
of a HummingBird 384-channel dispenser. These plates were used directly for the assay
which was performed in a total volume of 9.05 µL. This led to a final compound concentration
of 10, 2.0, 0.4, 0.08, 0.016, 0.0032, 0.00064 and 0.000128 µM and a final DMSO concentration
of 0.5 % in the assay.
Cellular Assays
[0503] To assess the ability of compounds of the invention to inhibit BCR-ABL1 activity
in cellular assays, compounds were evaluated for their ability to selectively inhibit
the proliferation of cells dependent on BCR-ABL1 expression relative to cells that
do not depend on BCR-ABL1 expression.
[0504] The murine bone marrow-derived cell line Ba/F3 was used to generate the appropriate
cell line models. Ba/F3 cells were obtained from the German Collection of Microorganisms
and Cell Cultures (DSMZ, Braunschweig and DSMZ No. ACC 300). Parental Ba/F3 cells
depend on IL3 for growth and survival and were used as the reference cell line that
does not depend on BCR-ABL1 activity for growth and survival. These cells are referred
to as Ba/F3-WT.
[0506] Ba/F3-WT cells were maintained in RPMI1640 media with L-glutamine, HEPES (Lonza),
10% FBS (Gibco) and 5ng/ml IL-3 (Calbiochem). Ba/F3-BCR-ABL1-WT cells and Ba/F3-BCR-ABL1-T315I
cells were manitained in RPMI1640 media with L-glutamine, HEPES (Lonza) and 10% FBS
(Gibco).
Proliferation assay
[0507] For each cell line, the cell density was adjusted to 50 000 cells/mL and 50 µL (2500
cells) added per well of a 384-well assay plate.
[0508] Test compounds were resuspended in DMSO at a concentration of 10 mM. A serial three-fold
dilution of each compound with DMSO was performed in 384-well plates using the Janus
Liquid Dispenser (PerkinElmer). Compound was delivered to the assay plates containing
2500 cells in a 50 µL volume via Acoustic delivery from an ATS-100 (EDC). For Ba/F3-BCR-ABL1-WT
cell assays, 2 nL of each compound dilution was transferred to the assay plate for
final assay concentrations of 0.4 µM, 0.13 µM, 0.044 µM, 0.015 µM, 0.005 µM, 0.001
µM, 0.00033 µM, 0.00011 µM, 0.000037 µM, 0.000012 µM. For Ba/F3-WT and Ba/F3-BCR-ABL1-T315I
cell assays, 50 nL of each compound dilution was transferred to the assay plate for
final assay concentrations of 10 µM, 3.33 µM, 1.11 µM, 0.37 µM, 0.12 µM, 0.041 µM,
0.014 µM, 0.0046 µM, 0.0015 µM, 0.00051 µM.
[0509] Cells were incubated at 37°C in a humidified environment with 5% carbon dioxide for
48 hours. Britelite plus solution (Perkin Elmer) was prepared according to the manufacturer's
instructions and 25 µL added to each well of the assay plate. Plates were incubated
for 3-5 minutes and the luminescence detected on an EnVision Multimode plate reader
(Perkin Elmer). The degree of luminescence correlates with the number of cells in
each well. The effect of each inhibitor concentration can therefore be calculated
and IC
50 values generated.
[0510] The compounds of the invention show IC
50 values in the range of 0.1 nM to 12 nM for inhibition of Abl kinase activity in a
radiometric filter binding (Radio). For a microfluidic mobilitiy shift assays (Caliper)
assay, IC
50 values can be found in the range of 0.1 nM to 10 nM. For Ba/F3-BCR-ABL-WT and T315I
cellular proliferation assay, GI
50 values can be found in the range of 0.8 nM to 110 nM and 13 nM to 4.2µM, respectively.

In vivo efficacy in KCL-22 xenograft model - single agent treatment
[0511] Compounds of the invention were dosed orally in a mouse KCL-22 xenograft model for
7 days. 6-8 week old female nude mice purchased from Harlan (Indianapolis IN) were
implanted subcutaneously with 5x10
6 KCL-22 cells in 50% matrigel (BD Biosciences, #354234) in the right dorsal axillary
region. Drug treatment was initiated when tumor volume reached an average of 238 mm
3 (10 days post tumor implantation). Compounds of the invention in phosphate buffered
saline were prepared weekly and dosed by oral gavage at 3-30mg/kg twice daily (n=6
mice per dose level). Tumor volume was determined by twice weekly digital calipering
and calculated as Length x Width
2 /2.
[0512] Compounds of the invention showed statistically significant regressions. For example,
a 3mg/kg twice daily dose of (R)-N-(4-(Chlorodifluoromethoxy)phenyl)-6-(3-hydroxypyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(1H-pyrazol-5-yl)nicotinamide
(Example 9) led to a tumor growth inhibition of 45% compared to vehicle-treated mice,
while regressions were observed of 56%, 88% and 92% at doses of 7.5, 15 and 30 mg/kg
twice daily dosing, respectively. As a positive control, nilotinib was dosed at 75mg/kg
twice daily resulting in a tumor regression of 82% (Figure 2).
In vivo efficacy in KCL-22 xenograft model - dual agent treatment
[0513] 6-8 week old female nude mice purchased from Harlan (Indianapolis IN) were implanted
subcutaneously with 2x10
6 KCL-22 cells in 50% matrigel (BD Biosciences, #354234) in the right dorsal axillary
region. Drug treatment was initiated when tumor volume reached an average of 189 mm
3 (9 days post tumor implantation). Compounds of the invention in a phosphate-buffered
saline solution were prepared weekly and dosed by oral gavage at 30mg/kg twice daily,
and Nilotinib solution was dosed at 75mg/kg twice daily. Animals received either single
agent alone or combination of both simultaneously. Tumor volume was determined by
twice weekly digital calipering and calculated as Length x Width
2 /2.
[0514] Animals treated with nilotinib alone achieved >84% tumor regression after 4 week
daily treatment, but most tumors relapsed to >500mm
3 thereafter . Animals with nilotinib-resistant tumors then received daily treatment
of Example 9, and continued to be monitored for tumor response (Figure 3).
[0515] Animals treated with nilotinib and Example 9 simultaneously demonstrated complete
tumor regression in all animals to the end of the study (Figure 4).